d7dce0d44dd86152d27770f4c0bb986653514838
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @set EDITION Ninth
32
33 @c !!set GDB manual's revision date
34 @set DATE June 2002
35
36 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
37 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
38
39 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
40
41 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
42 @c manuals to an info tree.
43 @dircategory Programming & development tools.
44 @direntry
45 * Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
46 @end direntry
47
48 @ifinfo
49 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
50
51
52 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
53 of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
54 for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
55
56 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
57 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
58
59 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
60 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
61 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
62 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
63 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
64 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
65
66 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
67 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
68 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
69 development.''
70 @end ifinfo
71
72 @titlepage
73 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
74 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
75 @sp 1
76 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
77 @subtitle @value{DATE}
78 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
79 @page
80 @tex
81 {\parskip=0pt
82 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
83 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
84 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
85 }
86 @end tex
87
88 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
89 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
90 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
91 @sp 2
92 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
93 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
94 Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
95 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
96
97 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
98 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
99 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
100 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
101 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
102 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
103
104 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
105 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
106 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
107 development.''
108 @end titlepage
109 @page
110
111 @ifnottex
112 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
113
114 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
115
116 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
117
118 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
119 @value{GDBVN}.
120
121 Copyright (C) 1988-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
122
123 @menu
124 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
125 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
126
127 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
128 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
129 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
130 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
131 * Stack:: Examining the stack
132 * Source:: Examining source files
133 * Data:: Examining data
134 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
135 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
136 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
137
138 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
139
140 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
141 * Altering:: Altering execution
142 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
143 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
144 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
145 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
146 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
147 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
148 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
149 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
151 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
152
153 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
155
156 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
157 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
158 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
159 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
160 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
161 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
162 how you can copy and share GDB
163 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
164 * Index:: Index
165 @end menu
166
167 @end ifnottex
168
169 @contents
170
171 @node Summary
172 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
173
174 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
175 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
176 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
177
178 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
179 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
180
181 @itemize @bullet
182 @item
183 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
184
185 @item
186 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
187
188 @item
189 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
190
191 @item
192 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
193 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
194 @end itemize
195
196 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
197 For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
198 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
199
200 @c OBSOLETE @cindex Chill
201 @cindex Modula-2
202 Support for Modula-2
203 @c OBSOLETE and Chill
204 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
205 @c OBSOLETE For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
206
207 @cindex Pascal
208 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
209 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
210 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
211 syntax.
212
213 @cindex Fortran
214 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
215 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
216 underscore.
217
218 @menu
219 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
220 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
221 @end menu
222
223 @node Free Software
224 @unnumberedsec Free software
225
226 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
227 General Public License
228 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
229 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
230 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
231 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
232 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
233 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
234
235 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
236 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
237 from anyone else.
238
239 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
240
241 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
242 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
243 include with the free software. Many of our most important
244 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
245 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
246 when an important free software package does not come with a free
247 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
248 gaps today.
249
250 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
251 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
252 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
253 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
254 them from the free software world.
255
256 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
257 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
258 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
259 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
260 contract to make it non-free.
261
262 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
263 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
264 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
265 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
266 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
267 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
268 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
269
270 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
271 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
272 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
273 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
274
275 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
276 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
277 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
278 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
279 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
280 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
281 community.
282
283 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
284 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
285 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
286 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
287 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
288 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
289 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
290 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
291 of the manual.
292
293 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
294 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
295 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
296 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
297 manual to replace it.
298
299 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
300 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
301 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
302 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
303 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
304 the free software community.
305
306 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
307 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
308 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
309 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
310 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
311 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
312 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
313 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
314 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
315
316 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
317 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
318 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
319 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
320 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
321 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
322 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
323 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
324
325 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
326 published by other publishers, at
327 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
328
329 @node Contributors
330 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
331
332 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
333 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
334 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
335 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
336 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
337 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
338 blow-by-blow account.
339
340 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
341
342 @quotation
343 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
344 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
345 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
346 @end quotation
347
348 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
349 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
350 releases:
351 Andrew Cagney (releases 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
352 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
353 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
354 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
355 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
356 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
357 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
358 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
359 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
360
361 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
362 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
363
364 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
365 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
366 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
367 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
368 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
369
370 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
371 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
372 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
373
374 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
375 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
376
377 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
378
379 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
380 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
381 support.
382 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
383 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
384 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
385 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
386 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
387 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
388 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
389 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
390 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
391 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
392 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
393 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
394 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
395 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
396 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
397
398 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
399
400 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
401 libraries.
402
403 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
404 about several machine instruction sets.
405
406 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
407 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
408 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
409 and RDI targets, respectively.
410
411 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
412 command-line editing and command history.
413
414 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
415 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
416
417 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
418 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
419 symbols.
420
421 Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
422 Super-H processors.
423
424 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
425
426 Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
427
428 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
429
430 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
431
432 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
433
434 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
435 watchpoints.
436
437 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
438
439 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
440
441 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
442 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
443
444 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
445 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
446 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
447 compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
448 John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
449 Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
450 information in this manual.
451
452 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
453 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
454
455 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
456 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
457 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
458 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
459 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
460 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
461 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
462 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
463 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
464 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
465 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
466 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
467 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
468 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
469 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
470
471 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
472 Hat.
473
474 @node Sample Session
475 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
476
477 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
478 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
479 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
480
481 @iftex
482 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
483 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
484 @end iftex
485
486 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
487 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
488
489 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
490 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
491 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
492 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
493 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
494 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
495 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
496 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
497 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
498
499 @smallexample
500 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
501 $ @b{./m4}
502 @b{define(foo,0000)}
503
504 @b{foo}
505 0000
506 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
507
508 @b{bar}
509 0000
510 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
511
512 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
513 @b{baz}
514 @b{C-d}
515 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
516 @end smallexample
517
518 @noindent
519 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
520
521 @smallexample
522 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
523 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
524 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
525 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
526 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
527 the conditions.
528 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
529 for details.
530
531 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
532 (@value{GDBP})
533 @end smallexample
534
535 @noindent
536 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
537 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
538 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
539 that examples fit in this manual.
540
541 @smallexample
542 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
543 @end smallexample
544
545 @noindent
546 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
547 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
548 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
549 @code{break} command.
550
551 @smallexample
552 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
553 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
554 @end smallexample
555
556 @noindent
557 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
558 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
559 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
560
561 @smallexample
562 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
563 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
564 @b{define(foo,0000)}
565
566 @b{foo}
567 0000
568 @end smallexample
569
570 @noindent
571 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
572 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
573 context where it stops.
574
575 @smallexample
576 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
577
578 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
579 at builtin.c:879
580 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
581 @end smallexample
582
583 @noindent
584 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
585 the next line of the current function.
586
587 @smallexample
588 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
589 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
590 : nil,
591 @end smallexample
592
593 @noindent
594 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
595 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
596 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
597 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
598
599 @smallexample
600 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
601 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
602 at input.c:530
603 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
604 @end smallexample
605
606 @noindent
607 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
608 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
609 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
610 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
611 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
612 stack frame for each active subroutine.
613
614 @smallexample
615 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
616 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
617 at input.c:530
618 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
619 at builtin.c:882
620 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
621 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
622 at macro.c:71
623 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
624 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
625 @end smallexample
626
627 @noindent
628 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
629 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
630 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
631
632 @smallexample
633 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
634 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
635 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
636 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
637 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
638 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
639 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
640 : xstrdup(rq);
641 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
642 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
647 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
648 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
649 (@code{print}) to see their values.
650
651 @smallexample
652 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
653 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
655 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
656 @end smallexample
657
658 @noindent
659 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
660 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
661 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
662
663 @smallexample
664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
665 533 xfree(rquote);
666 534
667 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
668 : xstrdup (lq);
669 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
670 : xstrdup (rq);
671 537
672 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
673 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
674 540 @}
675 541
676 542 void
677 @end smallexample
678
679 @noindent
680 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
681 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
682
683 @smallexample
684 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
685 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
687 540 @}
688 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
689 $3 = 9
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
691 $4 = 7
692 @end smallexample
693
694 @noindent
695 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
696 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
697 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
698 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
699 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
700 assignments.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
704 $5 = 7
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
706 $6 = 9
707 @end smallexample
708
709 @noindent
710 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
711 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
712 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
713 example that caused trouble initially:
714
715 @smallexample
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
717 Continuing.
718
719 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
720
721 baz
722 0000
723 @end smallexample
724
725 @noindent
726 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
727 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
728 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
729
730 @smallexample
731 @b{C-d}
732 Program exited normally.
733 @end smallexample
734
735 @noindent
736 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
737 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
738 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
739
740 @smallexample
741 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
742 @end smallexample
743
744 @node Invocation
745 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
746
747 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
748 The essentials are:
749 @itemize @bullet
750 @item
751 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
752 @item
753 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
754 @end itemize
755
756 @menu
757 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
758 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
759 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
760 @end menu
761
762 @node Invoking GDB
763 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
764
765 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
766 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
767
768 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
769 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
770
771 The command-line options described here are designed
772 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
773 options may effectively be unavailable.
774
775 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
776 specifying an executable program:
777
778 @smallexample
779 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
780 @end smallexample
781
782 @noindent
783 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
784 specified:
785
786 @smallexample
787 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
788 @end smallexample
789
790 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
791 to debug a running process:
792
793 @smallexample
794 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
795 @end smallexample
796
797 @noindent
798 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
799 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
800
801 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
802 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
803 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
804 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
805 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
806
807 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
808 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
809 option processing.
810 @smallexample
811 gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
812 @end smallexample
813 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
814 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
815
816 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
817 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
818
819 @smallexample
820 @value{GDBP} -silent
821 @end smallexample
822
823 @noindent
824 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
825 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
826
827 @noindent
828 Type
829
830 @smallexample
831 @value{GDBP} -help
832 @end smallexample
833
834 @noindent
835 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
836 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
837
838 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
839 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
840 @samp{-x} option is used.
841
842
843 @menu
844 * File Options:: Choosing files
845 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
846 @end menu
847
848 @node File Options
849 @subsection Choosing files
850
851 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
852 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
853 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
854 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
855 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
856 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
857 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
858 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
859 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
860 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
861 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
862 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
863 prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
864
865 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
866 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
867 argument and ignore it.
868
869 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
870 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
871 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
872 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
873 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
874
875 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
876 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
877 @c it.
878
879 @table @code
880 @item -symbols @var{file}
881 @itemx -s @var{file}
882 @cindex @code{--symbols}
883 @cindex @code{-s}
884 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
885
886 @item -exec @var{file}
887 @itemx -e @var{file}
888 @cindex @code{--exec}
889 @cindex @code{-e}
890 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
891 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
892
893 @item -se @var{file}
894 @cindex @code{--se}
895 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
896 file.
897
898 @item -core @var{file}
899 @itemx -c @var{file}
900 @cindex @code{--core}
901 @cindex @code{-c}
902 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
903
904 @item -c @var{number}
905 @item -pid @var{number}
906 @itemx -p @var{number}
907 @cindex @code{--pid}
908 @cindex @code{-p}
909 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
910 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
911 file named @var{number}.
912
913 @item -command @var{file}
914 @itemx -x @var{file}
915 @cindex @code{--command}
916 @cindex @code{-x}
917 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
918 Files,, Command files}.
919
920 @item -directory @var{directory}
921 @itemx -d @var{directory}
922 @cindex @code{--directory}
923 @cindex @code{-d}
924 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
925
926 @item -m
927 @itemx -mapped
928 @cindex @code{--mapped}
929 @cindex @code{-m}
930 @emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
931 supported on all systems.}@*
932 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
933 system call, you can use this option
934 to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
935 program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
936 called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
937 Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
938 and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
939 the symbol table from the executable program.
940
941 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
942 is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
943 table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
944
945 @item -r
946 @itemx -readnow
947 @cindex @code{--readnow}
948 @cindex @code{-r}
949 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
950 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
951 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
952
953 @end table
954
955 You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
956 order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
957 information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
958 on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
959 but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
960
961 @smallexample
962 gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
963 @end smallexample
964
965 @node Mode Options
966 @subsection Choosing modes
967
968 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
969 batch mode or quiet mode.
970
971 @table @code
972 @item -nx
973 @itemx -n
974 @cindex @code{--nx}
975 @cindex @code{-n}
976 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
977 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
978 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
979 files}.
980
981 @item -quiet
982 @itemx -silent
983 @itemx -q
984 @cindex @code{--quiet}
985 @cindex @code{--silent}
986 @cindex @code{-q}
987 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
988 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
989
990 @item -batch
991 @cindex @code{--batch}
992 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
993 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
994 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
995 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
996 in the command files.
997
998 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
999 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1000 make this more useful, the message
1001
1002 @smallexample
1003 Program exited normally.
1004 @end smallexample
1005
1006 @noindent
1007 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1008 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1009 mode.
1010
1011 @item -nowindows
1012 @itemx -nw
1013 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1014 @cindex @code{-nw}
1015 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1016 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1017 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1018
1019 @item -windows
1020 @itemx -w
1021 @cindex @code{--windows}
1022 @cindex @code{-w}
1023 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1024 used if possible.
1025
1026 @item -cd @var{directory}
1027 @cindex @code{--cd}
1028 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1029 instead of the current directory.
1030
1031 @item -fullname
1032 @itemx -f
1033 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1034 @cindex @code{-f}
1035 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1036 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1037 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1038 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1039 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1040 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1041 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1042 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1043 frame.
1044
1045 @item -epoch
1046 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1047 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1048 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1049 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1050 separate window.
1051
1052 @item -annotate @var{level}
1053 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1054 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1055 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1056 (@pxref{Annotations}).
1057 Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
1058 together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
1059 types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
1060 @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
1061 maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
1062
1063 @item -async
1064 @cindex @code{--async}
1065 Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1066 @value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1067 special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1068 commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1069 run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1070 MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1071 suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1072 control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
1073 (@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
1074 operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1075 yet.)
1076 @c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1077 @c should be removed.
1078
1079 When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1080 uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1081 @samp{-noasync} option.
1082
1083 @item -noasync
1084 @cindex @code{--noasync}
1085 Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1086
1087 @item --args
1088 @cindex @code{--args}
1089 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1090 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1091 This option stops option processing.
1092
1093 @item -baud @var{bps}
1094 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1095 @cindex @code{--baud}
1096 @cindex @code{-b}
1097 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1098 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1099
1100 @item -tty @var{device}
1101 @itemx -t @var{device}
1102 @cindex @code{--tty}
1103 @cindex @code{-t}
1104 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1105 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1106
1107 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1108 @item -tui
1109 @cindex @code{--tui}
1110 Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1111 The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1112 showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1113 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1114 Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1115 (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1116
1117 @c @item -xdb
1118 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1119 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1120 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1121 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1122 @c systems.
1123
1124 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1125 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1126 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1127 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1128 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1129
1130 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi1}) causes
1131 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdb/mi interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The
1132 @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The older @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in
1133 @value{GDBN} version 5.0 can be selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi0}.
1134
1135 @item -write
1136 @cindex @code{--write}
1137 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1138 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1139 (@pxref{Patching}).
1140
1141 @item -statistics
1142 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1143 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1144 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1145
1146 @item -version
1147 @cindex @code{--version}
1148 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1149 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1150
1151 @end table
1152
1153 @node Quitting GDB
1154 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1155 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1156 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1157
1158 @table @code
1159 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1160 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1161 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1162 @itemx q
1163 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1164 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1165 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1166 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1167 error code.
1168 @end table
1169
1170 @cindex interrupt
1171 An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1172 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1173 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1174 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1175 until a time when it is safe.
1176
1177 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1178 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1179 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1180
1181 @node Shell Commands
1182 @section Shell commands
1183
1184 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1185 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1186 just use the @code{shell} command.
1187
1188 @table @code
1189 @kindex shell
1190 @cindex shell escape
1191 @item shell @var{command string}
1192 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1193 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1194 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1195 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1196 @end table
1197
1198 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1199 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1200 @value{GDBN}:
1201
1202 @table @code
1203 @kindex make
1204 @cindex calling make
1205 @item make @var{make-args}
1206 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1207 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1208 @end table
1209
1210 @node Commands
1211 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1212
1213 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1214 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1215 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1216 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1217 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1218
1219 @menu
1220 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1221 * Completion:: Command completion
1222 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1223 @end menu
1224
1225 @node Command Syntax
1226 @section Command syntax
1227
1228 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1229 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1230 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1231 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1232 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1233 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1234
1235 @cindex abbreviation
1236 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1237 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1238 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1239 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1240 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1241 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1242 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1243
1244 @cindex repeating commands
1245 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1246 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1247 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1248 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1249 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1250 repeat.
1251
1252 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1253 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1254 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1255
1256 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1257 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1258 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1259 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1260 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1261
1262 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1263 @cindex comment
1264 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1265 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1266 Files,,Command files}).
1267
1268 @cindex repeating command sequences
1269 @kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1270 The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1271 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1272 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1273 for editing.
1274
1275 @node Completion
1276 @section Command completion
1277
1278 @cindex completion
1279 @cindex word completion
1280 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1281 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1282 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1283 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1284
1285 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1286 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1287 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1288 enter it). For example, if you type
1289
1290 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1291 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1292 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1293 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1294 @smallexample
1295 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1296 @end smallexample
1297
1298 @noindent
1299 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1300 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1301
1302 @smallexample
1303 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1304 @end smallexample
1305
1306 @noindent
1307 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1308 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1309 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1310 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1311 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1312 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1313
1314 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1315 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1316 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1317 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1318 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1319 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1320 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1321 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1322 example:
1323
1324 @smallexample
1325 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1326 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1327 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1328 make_abs_section make_function_type
1329 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1330 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1331 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1332 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1333 @end smallexample
1334
1335 @noindent
1336 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1337 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1338 command.
1339
1340 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1341 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1342 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1343 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1344 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1345
1346 @cindex quotes in commands
1347 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1348 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1349 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1350 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1351 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1352 @value{GDBN} commands.
1353
1354 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1355 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1356 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1357 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1358 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1359 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1360 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1361 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1362 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1363 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1364 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1365
1366 @smallexample
1367 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1368 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1369 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1370 @end smallexample
1371
1372 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1373 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1374 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1375 place:
1376
1377 @smallexample
1378 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1379 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1380 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1381 @end smallexample
1382
1383 @noindent
1384 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1385 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1386 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1387
1388 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1389 expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1390 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1391 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1392
1393
1394 @node Help
1395 @section Getting help
1396 @cindex online documentation
1397 @kindex help
1398
1399 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1400 using the command @code{help}.
1401
1402 @table @code
1403 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1404 @item help
1405 @itemx h
1406 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1407 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1408
1409 @smallexample
1410 (@value{GDBP}) help
1411 List of classes of commands:
1412
1413 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1414 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1415 data -- Examining data
1416 files -- Specifying and examining files
1417 internals -- Maintenance commands
1418 obscure -- Obscure features
1419 running -- Running the program
1420 stack -- Examining the stack
1421 status -- Status inquiries
1422 support -- Support facilities
1423 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1424 stopping the program
1425 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1426
1427 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1428 commands in that class.
1429 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1430 documentation.
1431 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1432 (@value{GDBP})
1433 @end smallexample
1434 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1435
1436 @item help @var{class}
1437 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1438 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1439 help display for the class @code{status}:
1440
1441 @smallexample
1442 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1443 Status inquiries.
1444
1445 List of commands:
1446
1447 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1448 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1449 info -- Generic command for showing things
1450 about the program being debugged
1451 show -- Generic command for showing things
1452 about the debugger
1453
1454 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1455 documentation.
1456 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1457 (@value{GDBP})
1458 @end smallexample
1459
1460 @item help @var{command}
1461 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1462 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1463
1464 @kindex apropos
1465 @item apropos @var{args}
1466 The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1467 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1468 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1469
1470 @smallexample
1471 apropos reload
1472 @end smallexample
1473
1474 @noindent
1475 results in:
1476
1477 @smallexample
1478 @c @group
1479 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1480 multiple times in one run
1481 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1482 multiple times in one run
1483 @c @end group
1484 @end smallexample
1485
1486 @kindex complete
1487 @item complete @var{args}
1488 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1489 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1490 command you want completed. For example:
1491
1492 @smallexample
1493 complete i
1494 @end smallexample
1495
1496 @noindent results in:
1497
1498 @smallexample
1499 @group
1500 if
1501 ignore
1502 info
1503 inspect
1504 @end group
1505 @end smallexample
1506
1507 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1508 @end table
1509
1510 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1511 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1512 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1513 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1514 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1515 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1516
1517 @c @group
1518 @table @code
1519 @kindex info
1520 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1521 @item info
1522 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1523 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1524 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1525 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1526 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1527 @w{@code{help info}}.
1528
1529 @kindex set
1530 @item set
1531 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1532 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1533 @code{set prompt $}.
1534
1535 @kindex show
1536 @item show
1537 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1538 @value{GDBN} itself.
1539 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1540 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1541 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1542 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1543
1544 @kindex info set
1545 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1546 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1547 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1548 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1549 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1550 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1551 @end table
1552 @c @end group
1553
1554 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1555 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1556
1557 @table @code
1558 @kindex show version
1559 @cindex version number
1560 @item show version
1561 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1562 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1563 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1564 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1565 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1566 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1567 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1568 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1569 @value{GDBN}.
1570
1571 @kindex show copying
1572 @item show copying
1573 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1574
1575 @kindex show warranty
1576 @item show warranty
1577 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1578 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1579
1580 @end table
1581
1582 @node Running
1583 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1584
1585 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1586 debugging information when you compile it.
1587
1588 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1589 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1590 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1591 kill a child process.
1592
1593 @menu
1594 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1595 * Starting:: Starting your program
1596 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1597 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1598
1599 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1600 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1601 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1602 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1603
1604 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1605 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1606 @end menu
1607
1608 @node Compilation
1609 @section Compiling for debugging
1610
1611 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1612 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1613 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1614 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1615 and addresses in the executable code.
1616
1617 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1618 the compiler.
1619
1620 Most compilers do not include information about preprocessor macros in
1621 the debugging information if you specify the @option{-g} flag alone,
1622 because this information is rather large. Version 3.1 of @value{NGCC},
1623 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you specify the
1624 options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1625 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1626 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact ways
1627 to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1628 @option{-g} alone.
1629
1630 Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1631 options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1632 executables containing debugging information.
1633
1634 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1635 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1636 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1637 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1638 in pushing your luck.
1639
1640 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1641 @cindex debugging optimized code
1642 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1643 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1644 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1645 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1646 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1647 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1648
1649 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1650 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1651 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1652 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1653
1654 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1655 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1656 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1657
1658 @need 2000
1659 @node Starting
1660 @section Starting your program
1661 @cindex starting
1662 @cindex running
1663
1664 @table @code
1665 @kindex run
1666 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1667 @item run
1668 @itemx r
1669 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1670 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1671 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1672 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1673 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1674
1675 @end table
1676
1677 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1678 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1679 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1680 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1681
1682 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1683 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1684 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1685 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1686 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1687 divided into four categories:
1688
1689 @table @asis
1690 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1691 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1692 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1693 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1694 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1695 the arguments.
1696 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1697 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1698 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1699
1700 @item The @emph{environment.}
1701 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1702 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1703 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1704 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1705
1706 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1707 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1708 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1709 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1710
1711 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1712 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1713 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1714 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1715 set a different device for your program.
1716 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1717
1718 @cindex pipes
1719 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1720 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1721 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1722 wrong program.
1723 @end table
1724
1725 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1726 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1727 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1728 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1729 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1730
1731 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1732 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1733 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1734 your current breakpoints.
1735
1736 @node Arguments
1737 @section Your program's arguments
1738
1739 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1740 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1741 @code{run} command.
1742 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1743 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1744 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1745 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1746 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1747
1748 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1749 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1750 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1751 the program, not by the shell.
1752
1753 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1754 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1755
1756 @table @code
1757 @kindex set args
1758 @item set args
1759 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1760 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1761 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1762 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1763 it again without arguments.
1764
1765 @kindex show args
1766 @item show args
1767 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1768 @end table
1769
1770 @node Environment
1771 @section Your program's environment
1772
1773 @cindex environment (of your program)
1774 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1775 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1776 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1777 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1778 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1779 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1780 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1781
1782 @table @code
1783 @kindex path
1784 @item path @var{directory}
1785 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1786 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1787 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1788 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1789 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1790 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1791 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1792
1793 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1794 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1795 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1796 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1797 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1798 @var{directory} to the search path.
1799 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1800 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1801
1802 @kindex show paths
1803 @item show paths
1804 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1805 environment variable).
1806
1807 @kindex show environment
1808 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1809 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1810 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1811 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1812 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1813
1814 @kindex set environment
1815 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1816 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1817 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1818 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1819 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1820 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1821 null value.
1822 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1823 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1824
1825 For example, this command:
1826
1827 @smallexample
1828 set env USER = foo
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent
1832 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
1833 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1834 are not actually required.)
1835
1836 @kindex unset environment
1837 @item unset environment @var{varname}
1838 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1839 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1840 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1841 rather than assigning it an empty value.
1842 @end table
1843
1844 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1845 the shell indicated
1846 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1847 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1848 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1849 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1850 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1851 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1852 @file{.profile}.
1853
1854 @node Working Directory
1855 @section Your program's working directory
1856
1857 @cindex working directory (of your program)
1858 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1859 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1860 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1861 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1862 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1863
1864 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1865 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1866 specify files}.
1867
1868 @table @code
1869 @kindex cd
1870 @item cd @var{directory}
1871 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1872
1873 @kindex pwd
1874 @item pwd
1875 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1876 @end table
1877
1878 @node Input/Output
1879 @section Your program's input and output
1880
1881 @cindex redirection
1882 @cindex i/o
1883 @cindex terminal
1884 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
1885 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
1886 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1887 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1888 running your program.
1889
1890 @table @code
1891 @kindex info terminal
1892 @item info terminal
1893 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1894 program is using.
1895 @end table
1896
1897 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1898 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1899
1900 @smallexample
1901 run > outfile
1902 @end smallexample
1903
1904 @noindent
1905 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1906
1907 @kindex tty
1908 @cindex controlling terminal
1909 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1910 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1911 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1912 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1913 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1914
1915 @smallexample
1916 tty /dev/ttyb
1917 @end smallexample
1918
1919 @noindent
1920 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1921 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1922 that as their controlling terminal.
1923
1924 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1925 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1926 terminal.
1927
1928 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1929 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1930 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1931
1932 @node Attach
1933 @section Debugging an already-running process
1934 @kindex attach
1935 @cindex attach
1936
1937 @table @code
1938 @item attach @var{process-id}
1939 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1940 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1941 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1942 find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1943 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1944
1945 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1946 executing the command.
1947 @end table
1948
1949 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1950 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1951 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1952 also have permission to send the process a signal.
1953
1954 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1955 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1956 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1957 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1958 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1959 Specify Files}.
1960
1961 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1962 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
1963 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1964 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1965 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1966 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
1967 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1968
1969 @table @code
1970 @kindex detach
1971 @item detach
1972 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1973 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1974 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1975 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1976 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1977 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1978 executing the command.
1979 @end table
1980
1981 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1982 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1983 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1984 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1985 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1986 messages}).
1987
1988 @node Kill Process
1989 @section Killing the child process
1990
1991 @table @code
1992 @kindex kill
1993 @item kill
1994 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1995 @end table
1996
1997 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1998 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1999 is running.
2000
2001 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2002 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2003 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2004 outside the debugger.
2005
2006 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2007 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2008 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2009 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2010 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2011 breakpoint settings).
2012
2013 @node Threads
2014 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
2015
2016 @cindex threads of execution
2017 @cindex multiple threads
2018 @cindex switching threads
2019 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2020 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2021 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2022 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2023 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2024 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2025 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2026
2027 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2028 programs:
2029
2030 @itemize @bullet
2031 @item automatic notification of new threads
2032 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2033 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2034 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2035 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2036 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2037 @end itemize
2038
2039 @quotation
2040 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2041 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2042 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2043 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2044 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2045 like this:
2046
2047 @smallexample
2048 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2049 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2050 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2051 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2052 @end smallexample
2053 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2054 @c doesn't support threads"?
2055 @end quotation
2056
2057 @cindex focus of debugging
2058 @cindex current thread
2059 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2060 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2061 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2062 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2063 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2064
2065 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2066 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2067 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2068 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2069 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2070 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2071 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2072 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2073 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2074 LynxOS, you might see
2075
2076 @smallexample
2077 [New process 35 thread 27]
2078 @end smallexample
2079
2080 @noindent
2081 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2082 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2083 further qualifier.
2084
2085 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2086 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2087 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2088 @c program?
2089 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2090 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2091 @c threads ab initio?
2092
2093 @cindex thread number
2094 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2095 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2096 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2097
2098 @table @code
2099 @kindex info threads
2100 @item info threads
2101 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2102 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2103
2104 @enumerate
2105 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2106
2107 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2108
2109 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2110 @end enumerate
2111
2112 @noindent
2113 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2114 indicates the current thread.
2115
2116 For example,
2117 @end table
2118 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2119
2120 @smallexample
2121 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2122 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2123 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2124 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2125 at threadtest.c:68
2126 @end smallexample
2127
2128 On HP-UX systems:
2129
2130 @cindex thread number
2131 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2132 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2133 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2134 thread in your program.
2135
2136 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2137 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2138 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2139 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2140 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2141 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2142 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2143 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2144 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2145 HP-UX, you see
2146
2147 @smallexample
2148 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2149 @end smallexample
2150
2151 @noindent
2152 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2153
2154 @table @code
2155 @kindex info threads
2156 @item info threads
2157 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2158 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2159
2160 @enumerate
2161 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2162
2163 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2164
2165 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2166 @end enumerate
2167
2168 @noindent
2169 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2170 indicates the current thread.
2171
2172 For example,
2173 @end table
2174 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2175
2176 @smallexample
2177 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2178 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2179 at quicksort.c:137
2180 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2181 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2182 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2183 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2184 @end smallexample
2185
2186 @table @code
2187 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2188 @item thread @var{threadno}
2189 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2190 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2191 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2192 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2193 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2194
2195 @smallexample
2196 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2197 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2198 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2199 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2200 @end smallexample
2201
2202 @noindent
2203 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2204 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2205 threads.
2206
2207 @kindex thread apply
2208 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2209 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2210 more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2211 with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2212 @value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
2213 threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2214 @code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
2215 @end table
2216
2217 @cindex automatic thread selection
2218 @cindex switching threads automatically
2219 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2220 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2221 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2222 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2223 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2224 thread.
2225
2226 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2227 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2228 programs with multiple threads.
2229
2230 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2231 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2232
2233 @node Processes
2234 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2235
2236 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2237 @cindex multiple processes
2238 @cindex processes, multiple
2239 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2240 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2241 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2242 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2243 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2244 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2245 will cause it to terminate.
2246
2247 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2248 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2249 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2250 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2251 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2252 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2253 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2254 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2255 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2256 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2257
2258 On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2259 debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2260 @code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
2261
2262 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2263 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2264
2265 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2266 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2267
2268 @table @code
2269 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2270 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2271 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2272 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2273 process. The @var{mode} can be:
2274
2275 @table @code
2276 @item parent
2277 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2278 unimpeded. This is the default.
2279
2280 @item child
2281 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2282 unimpeded.
2283
2284 @item ask
2285 The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2286 @end table
2287
2288 @item show follow-fork-mode
2289 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2290 @end table
2291
2292 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2293 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2294 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2295 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2296 the child process's @code{main}.
2297
2298 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2299 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2300
2301 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2302 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2303 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2304 argument.
2305
2306 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2307 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2308 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2309
2310 @node Stopping
2311 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2312
2313 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2314 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2315 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2316
2317 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2318 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2319 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2320 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2321 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2322 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2323 explicitly request this information at any time.
2324
2325 @table @code
2326 @kindex info program
2327 @item info program
2328 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2329 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2330 @end table
2331
2332 @menu
2333 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2334 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2335 * Signals:: Signals
2336 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2337 @end menu
2338
2339 @node Breakpoints
2340 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2341
2342 @cindex breakpoints
2343 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2344 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2345 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2346 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2347 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2348 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2349 program.
2350
2351 In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2352 breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2353 a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2354 is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2355 not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2356 arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2357
2358 @cindex watchpoints
2359 @cindex memory tracing
2360 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2361 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2362 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2363 when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2364 command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2365 watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2366 any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2367 and watchpoints using the same commands.
2368
2369 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2370 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2371 Automatic display}.
2372
2373 @cindex catchpoints
2374 @cindex breakpoint on events
2375 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2376 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2377 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2378 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2379 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2380 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2381 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2382
2383 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2384 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2385 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2386 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2387 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2388 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2389 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2390 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2391 enable it again.
2392
2393 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2394 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2395 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2396 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2397 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2398 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2399 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2400
2401 @menu
2402 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2403 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2404 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2405 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2406 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2407 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2408 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2409 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2410 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2411 @end menu
2412
2413 @node Set Breaks
2414 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2415
2416 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2417 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2418 @c
2419 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2420
2421 @kindex break
2422 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2423 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2424 @cindex latest breakpoint
2425 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2426 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2427 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2428 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2429 convenience variables.
2430
2431 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2432
2433 @table @code
2434 @item break @var{function}
2435 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2436 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2437 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2438 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2439
2440 @item break +@var{offset}
2441 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2442 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2443 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2444 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2445
2446 @item break @var{linenum}
2447 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2448 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2449 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2450 code on that line.
2451
2452 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2453 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2454
2455 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2456 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2457 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2458 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2459 functions.
2460
2461 @item break *@var{address}
2462 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2463 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2464 information or source files.
2465
2466 @item break
2467 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2468 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2469 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2470 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2471 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2472 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2473 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2474 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2475 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2476 inside loops.
2477
2478 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2479 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2480 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2481 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2482 existed when your program stopped.
2483
2484 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2485 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2486 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2487 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2488 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2489 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2490 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2491
2492 @kindex tbreak
2493 @item tbreak @var{args}
2494 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2495 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2496 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2497 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2498
2499 @kindex hbreak
2500 @item hbreak @var{args}
2501 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2502 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2503 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2504 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2505 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2506 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2507 provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2508 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2509 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2510 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2511 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2512 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2513 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2514 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2515
2516 @kindex thbreak
2517 @item thbreak @var{args}
2518 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2519 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2520 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2521 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2522 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2523 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2524 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2525 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2526
2527 @kindex rbreak
2528 @cindex regular expression
2529 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2530 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2531 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2532 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2533 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2534 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2535 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2536
2537 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2538 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2539 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2540 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2541 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2542 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2543
2544 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2545 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2546 classes.
2547
2548 @kindex info breakpoints
2549 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2550 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2551 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2552 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2553 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2554 not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2555
2556 @table @emph
2557 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2558 @item Type
2559 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2560 @item Disposition
2561 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2562 @item Enabled or Disabled
2563 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2564 that are not enabled.
2565 @item Address
2566 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
2567 @item What
2568 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2569 line number.
2570 @end table
2571
2572 @noindent
2573 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2574 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2575 are listed after that.
2576
2577 @noindent
2578 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
2579 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2580 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2581 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2582 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2583
2584 @noindent
2585 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2586 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2587 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2588 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2589 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2590 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2591 @end table
2592
2593 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2594 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2595 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2596 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2597
2598 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2599 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2600 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2601 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2602 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2603 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2604 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2605 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
2606
2607
2608 @node Set Watchpoints
2609 @subsection Setting watchpoints
2610
2611 @cindex setting watchpoints
2612 @cindex software watchpoints
2613 @cindex hardware watchpoints
2614 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2615 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2616 this may happen.
2617
2618 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2619 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
2620 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2621 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2622 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2623 culprit.)
2624
2625 On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2626 @value{GDBN} includes support for
2627 hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2628 program.
2629
2630 @table @code
2631 @kindex watch
2632 @item watch @var{expr}
2633 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2634 is written into by the program and its value changes.
2635
2636 @kindex rwatch
2637 @item rwatch @var{expr}
2638 Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
2639
2640 @kindex awatch
2641 @item awatch @var{expr}
2642 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
2643 by the program.
2644
2645 @kindex info watchpoints
2646 @item info watchpoints
2647 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2648 it is the same as @code{info break}.
2649 @end table
2650
2651 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2652 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2653 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2654 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2655 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2656 statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2657
2658 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2659
2660 @smallexample
2661 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2662 @end smallexample
2663
2664 @noindent
2665 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2666
2667 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2668 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2669 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2670 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2671 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2672 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2673 will print a message like this:
2674
2675 @smallexample
2676 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2677 @end smallexample
2678
2679 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2680 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2681 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2682 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2683 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2684 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2685 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2686 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2687
2688 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2689 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2690 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2691 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2692 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2693 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2694
2695 @smallexample
2696 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2697 @end smallexample
2698
2699 @noindent
2700 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2701
2702 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2703 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2704 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2705 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2706 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2707 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2708 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2709 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
2710 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2711 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2712
2713 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2714 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
2715 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2716
2717 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2718 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2719 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2720 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2721 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2722 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2723 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2724 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2725 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2726
2727 @quotation
2728 @cindex watchpoints and threads
2729 @cindex threads and watchpoints
2730 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2731 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2732 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2733 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2734 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2735 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2736 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2737 the expression.
2738
2739 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
2740 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2741 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2742 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2743 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2744 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2745 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2746 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2747 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2748 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
2749 @end quotation
2750
2751 @node Set Catchpoints
2752 @subsection Setting catchpoints
2753 @cindex catchpoints, setting
2754 @cindex exception handlers
2755 @cindex event handling
2756
2757 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2758 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
2759 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2760
2761 @table @code
2762 @kindex catch
2763 @item catch @var{event}
2764 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2765 @table @code
2766 @item throw
2767 @kindex catch throw
2768 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
2769
2770 @item catch
2771 @kindex catch catch
2772 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
2773
2774 @item exec
2775 @kindex catch exec
2776 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2777
2778 @item fork
2779 @kindex catch fork
2780 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2781
2782 @item vfork
2783 @kindex catch vfork
2784 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2785
2786 @item load
2787 @itemx load @var{libname}
2788 @kindex catch load
2789 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2790 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2791
2792 @item unload
2793 @itemx unload @var{libname}
2794 @kindex catch unload
2795 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2796 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2797 @end table
2798
2799 @item tcatch @var{event}
2800 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2801 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2802
2803 @end table
2804
2805 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2806
2807 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
2808 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2809
2810 @itemize @bullet
2811 @item
2812 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2813 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2814 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2815 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2816 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2817 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2818 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2819 disabled within interactive calls.
2820
2821 @item
2822 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2823
2824 @item
2825 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2826 @end itemize
2827
2828 @cindex raise exceptions
2829 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2830 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2831 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2832 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2833 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2834 out where the exception was raised.
2835
2836 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2837 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
2838 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2839 which has the following ANSI C interface:
2840
2841 @smallexample
2842 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
2843 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2844 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
2845 @end smallexample
2846
2847 @noindent
2848 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2849 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2850 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2851
2852 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2853 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2854 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2855 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2856 raised.
2857
2858
2859 @node Delete Breaks
2860 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
2861
2862 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2863 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2864 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2865 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2866 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2867 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2868
2869 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2870 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2871 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2872 their breakpoint numbers.
2873
2874 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2875 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2876 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2877
2878 @table @code
2879 @kindex clear
2880 @item clear
2881 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2882 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2883 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2884 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2885
2886 @item clear @var{function}
2887 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2888 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2889
2890 @item clear @var{linenum}
2891 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2892 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2893
2894 @cindex delete breakpoints
2895 @kindex delete
2896 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
2897 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2898 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2899 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
2900 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2901 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2902 @end table
2903
2904 @node Disabling
2905 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
2906
2907 @kindex disable breakpoints
2908 @kindex enable breakpoints
2909 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2910 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2911 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2912 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2913
2914 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2915 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2916 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2917 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2918 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2919
2920 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2921 states of enablement:
2922
2923 @itemize @bullet
2924 @item
2925 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2926 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2927 @item
2928 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2929 @item
2930 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
2931 disabled.
2932 @item
2933 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
2934 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2935 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
2936 @end itemize
2937
2938 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2939 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2940
2941 @table @code
2942 @kindex disable breakpoints
2943 @kindex disable
2944 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
2945 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2946 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2947 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2948 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2949 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2950 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2951
2952 @kindex enable breakpoints
2953 @kindex enable
2954 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2955 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2956 become effective once again in stopping your program.
2957
2958 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
2959 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2960 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2961
2962 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
2963 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2964 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2965 @end table
2966
2967 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2968 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
2969 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2970 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2971 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2972 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2973 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2974 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2975 stepping}.)
2976
2977 @node Conditions
2978 @subsection Break conditions
2979 @cindex conditional breakpoints
2980 @cindex breakpoint conditions
2981
2982 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
2983 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
2984 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2985 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2986 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2987 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2988 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2989 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2990
2991 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2992 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2993 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2994 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2995 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2996
2997 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2998 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2999 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3000 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3001 one.
3002
3003 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3004 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3005 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3006 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3007 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3008 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3009 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3010 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3011 conditions for the
3012 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3013 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3014
3015 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3016 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3017 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3018 with the @code{condition} command.
3019
3020 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3021 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3022 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3023 catchpoint.
3024
3025 @table @code
3026 @kindex condition
3027 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3028 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3029 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3030 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3031 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3032 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3033 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3034 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3035 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3036 prints an error message:
3037
3038 @smallexample
3039 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3040 @end smallexample
3041
3042 @noindent
3043 @value{GDBN} does
3044 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3045 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3046 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3047
3048 @item condition @var{bnum}
3049 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3050 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3051 @end table
3052
3053 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3054 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3055 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3056 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3057 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3058 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3059 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3060 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3061 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3062 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3063 your program reaches it.
3064
3065 @table @code
3066 @kindex ignore
3067 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3068 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3069 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3070 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3071 takes no action.
3072
3073 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3074 a count of zero.
3075
3076 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3077 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3078 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3079 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3080
3081 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3082 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3083 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3084
3085 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3086 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3087 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3088 variables}.
3089 @end table
3090
3091 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3092
3093
3094 @node Break Commands
3095 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3096
3097 @cindex breakpoint commands
3098 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3099 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3100 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3101 enable other breakpoints.
3102
3103 @table @code
3104 @kindex commands
3105 @kindex end
3106 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3107 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3108 @itemx end
3109 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3110 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3111 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3112
3113 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3114 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3115
3116 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3117 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3118 recently encountered).
3119 @end table
3120
3121 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3122 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3123
3124 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3125 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3126 that resumes execution.
3127
3128 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3129 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3130 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3131 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3132 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3133
3134 @kindex silent
3135 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3136 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3137 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3138 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3139 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3140 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3141
3142 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3143 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3144 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3145
3146 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3147 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3148
3149 @smallexample
3150 break foo if x>0
3151 commands
3152 silent
3153 printf "x is %d\n",x
3154 cont
3155 end
3156 @end smallexample
3157
3158 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3159 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3160 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3161 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3162 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3163 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3164 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3165
3166 @smallexample
3167 break 403
3168 commands
3169 silent
3170 set x = y + 4
3171 cont
3172 end
3173 @end smallexample
3174
3175 @node Breakpoint Menus
3176 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3177 @cindex overloading
3178 @cindex symbol overloading
3179
3180 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
3181 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3182 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3183 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3184 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3185 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3186 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3187 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3188 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3189 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3190 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3191 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3192 breakpoints.
3193
3194 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3195 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3196 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3197
3198 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3199 @smallexample
3200 @group
3201 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3202 [0] cancel
3203 [1] all
3204 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3205 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3206 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3207 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3208 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3209 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3210 > 2 4 6
3211 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3212 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3213 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3214 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3215 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3216 breakpoints.
3217 (@value{GDBP})
3218 @end group
3219 @end smallexample
3220
3221 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3222 @node Error in Breakpoints
3223 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3224 @c
3225 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3226 @c
3227 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3228 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3229 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3230 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3231
3232 @smallexample
3233 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3234 The same program may be running in another process.
3235 @end smallexample
3236
3237 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3238
3239 @enumerate
3240 @item
3241 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3242
3243 @item
3244 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3245 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3246 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3247 Then start your program again.
3248
3249 @item
3250 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3251 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3252 to nonsharable executables.
3253 @end enumerate
3254 @c @end ifclear
3255
3256 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3257 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3258
3259 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3260 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3261 @smallexample
3262 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3263 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3264 @end smallexample
3265
3266 @noindent
3267 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3268 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3269 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3270
3271 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3272 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3273
3274
3275 @node Continuing and Stepping
3276 @section Continuing and stepping
3277
3278 @cindex stepping
3279 @cindex continuing
3280 @cindex resuming execution
3281 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3282 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3283 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3284 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3285 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3286 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3287 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3288 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3289
3290 @table @code
3291 @kindex continue
3292 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3293 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3294 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3295 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3296 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3297 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3298 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3299 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3300 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3301 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3302
3303 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3304 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3305 @code{continue} is ignored.
3306
3307 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3308 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3309 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3310 @code{continue}.
3311 @end table
3312
3313 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3314 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3315 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3316 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3317
3318 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3319 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3320 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3321 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3322 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3323 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3324
3325 @table @code
3326 @kindex step
3327 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3328 @item step
3329 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3330 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3331 abbreviated @code{s}.
3332
3333 @quotation
3334 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3335 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3336 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3337 @c distinction here.
3338 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3339 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3340 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3341 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3342 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3343 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3344 below.
3345 @end quotation
3346
3347 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3348 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3349 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3350 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3351 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3352 called within the line.
3353
3354 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3355 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3356 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3357 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3358 was any debugging information about the routine.
3359
3360 @item step @var{count}
3361 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3362 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3363 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3364
3365 @kindex next
3366 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3367 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3368 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3369 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3370 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3371 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3372 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3373 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3374
3375 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3376
3377
3378 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3379 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3380 @c
3381 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3382 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3383 @c function are executed without stopping.
3384
3385 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3386 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3387 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
3388
3389 @kindex set step-mode
3390 @item set step-mode
3391 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3392 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3393 @itemx set step-mode on
3394 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
3395 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3396 information rather than stepping over it.
3397
3398 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3399 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3400 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
3401
3402 @item set step-mode off
3403 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
3404 debug information. This is the default.
3405
3406 @kindex finish
3407 @item finish
3408 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3409 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3410
3411 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3412 ,Returning from a function}).
3413
3414 @kindex until
3415 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
3416 @item until
3417 @itemx u
3418 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3419 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3420 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3421 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3422 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3423 than the address of the jump.
3424
3425 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3426 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3427 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3428 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3429 through the next iteration.
3430
3431 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3432 stack frame.
3433
3434 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3435 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3436 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3437 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3438 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3439
3440 @smallexample
3441 (@value{GDBP}) f
3442 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3443 206 expand_input();
3444 (@value{GDBP}) until
3445 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3446 @end smallexample
3447
3448 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3449 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3450 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3451 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3452 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3453 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3454 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3455
3456 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3457 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3458 argument.
3459
3460 @item until @var{location}
3461 @itemx u @var{location}
3462 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3463 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3464 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3465 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3466 and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3467
3468 @kindex stepi
3469 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
3470 @item stepi
3471 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
3472 @itemx si
3473 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3474
3475 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3476 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3477 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3478 Display,, Automatic display}.
3479
3480 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3481
3482 @need 750
3483 @kindex nexti
3484 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
3485 @item nexti
3486 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
3487 @itemx ni
3488 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3489 proceed until the function returns.
3490
3491 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3492 @end table
3493
3494 @node Signals
3495 @section Signals
3496 @cindex signals
3497
3498 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3499 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3500 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
3501 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
3502 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3503 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3504 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3505 requested an alarm).
3506
3507 @cindex fatal signals
3508 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3509 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
3510 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
3511 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3512 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3513 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3514
3515 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3516 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3517 signal.
3518
3519 @cindex handling signals
3520 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3521 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3522 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
3523 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3524 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3525
3526 @table @code
3527 @kindex info signals
3528 @item info signals
3529 @itemx info handle
3530 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3531 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3532 the defined types of signals.
3533
3534 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
3535
3536 @kindex handle
3537 @item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3538 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3539 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
3540 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
3541 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3542 known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3543 @end table
3544
3545 @c @group
3546 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3547 Their full names are:
3548
3549 @table @code
3550 @item nostop
3551 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3552 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3553
3554 @item stop
3555 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3556 the @code{print} keyword as well.
3557
3558 @item print
3559 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3560
3561 @item noprint
3562 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3563 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3564
3565 @item pass
3566 @itemx noignore
3567 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3568 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3569 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
3570
3571 @item nopass
3572 @itemx ignore
3573 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3574 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
3575 @end table
3576 @c @end group
3577
3578 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3579 program until you
3580 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3581 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3582 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3583 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3584 program sees that signal when you continue.
3585
3586 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3587 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3588 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3589 erroneous signals.
3590
3591 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3592 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3593 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3594 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3595 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3596 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3597 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3598 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3599 program a signal}.
3600
3601 @node Thread Stops
3602 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3603
3604 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3605 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3606 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3607
3608 @table @code
3609 @cindex breakpoints and threads
3610 @cindex thread breakpoints
3611 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3612 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3613 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3614 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3615 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3616
3617 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3618 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3619 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3620 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3621 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3622
3623 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3624 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3625 program.
3626
3627 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3628 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3629 breakpoint condition, like this:
3630
3631 @smallexample
3632 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
3633 @end smallexample
3634
3635 @end table
3636
3637 @cindex stopped threads
3638 @cindex threads, stopped
3639 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3640 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3641 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3642 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3643 underfoot.
3644
3645 @cindex continuing threads
3646 @cindex threads, continuing
3647 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3648 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
3649 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
3650
3651 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3652 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3653 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3654 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3655 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3656 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3657 stops.
3658
3659 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3660 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3661 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3662 first thread completes whatever you requested.
3663
3664 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3665 thread to run.
3666
3667 @table @code
3668 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3669 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3670 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3671 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3672 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3673 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3674 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
3675 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
3676 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
3677 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
3678 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
3679 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
3680
3681 @item show scheduler-locking
3682 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3683 @end table
3684
3685
3686 @node Stack
3687 @chapter Examining the Stack
3688
3689 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3690 stopped and how it got there.
3691
3692 @cindex call stack
3693 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3694 is generated.
3695 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3696 the arguments of the call,
3697 and the local variables of the function being called.
3698 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
3699 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3700 stack}.
3701
3702 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3703 stack allow you to see all of this information.
3704
3705 @cindex selected frame
3706 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3707 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3708 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3709 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3710 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3711 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3712
3713 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
3714 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
3715 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3716
3717 @menu
3718 * Frames:: Stack frames
3719 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
3720 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
3721 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
3722
3723 @end menu
3724
3725 @node Frames
3726 @section Stack frames
3727
3728 @cindex frame, definition
3729 @cindex stack frame
3730 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3731 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3732 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3733 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3734 which the function is executing.
3735
3736 @cindex initial frame
3737 @cindex outermost frame
3738 @cindex innermost frame
3739 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3740 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3741 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3742 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3743 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3744 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3745 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3746 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3747
3748 @cindex frame pointer
3749 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3750 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3751 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3752 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3753 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3754 going on in that frame.
3755
3756 @cindex frame number
3757 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3758 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3759 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3760 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3761 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3762
3763 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3764 @c underflow problems.
3765 @cindex frameless execution
3766 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
3767 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3768 @smallexample
3769 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3770 @end smallexample
3771 generates functions without a frame.)
3772 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3773 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3774 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3775 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3776 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3777 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3778 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3779
3780 @table @code
3781 @kindex frame@r{, command}
3782 @cindex current stack frame
3783 @item frame @var{args}
3784 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
3785 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
3786 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3787 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
3788
3789 @kindex select-frame
3790 @cindex selecting frame silently
3791 @item select-frame
3792 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3793 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3794 @code{frame}.
3795 @end table
3796
3797 @node Backtrace
3798 @section Backtraces
3799
3800 @cindex backtraces
3801 @cindex tracebacks
3802 @cindex stack traces
3803 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3804 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3805 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3806 stack.
3807
3808 @table @code
3809 @kindex backtrace
3810 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
3811 @item backtrace
3812 @itemx bt
3813 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3814 frames in the stack.
3815
3816 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3817 character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3818
3819 @item backtrace @var{n}
3820 @itemx bt @var{n}
3821 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3822
3823 @item backtrace -@var{n}
3824 @itemx bt -@var{n}
3825 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3826 @end table
3827
3828 @kindex where
3829 @kindex info stack
3830 @kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
3831 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3832 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3833
3834 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3835 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3836 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3837 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3838 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3839 line number.
3840
3841 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3842 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3843
3844 @smallexample
3845 @group
3846 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
3847 at builtin.c:993
3848 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3849 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3850 at macro.c:71
3851 (More stack frames follow...)
3852 @end group
3853 @end smallexample
3854
3855 @noindent
3856 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3857 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3858 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3859
3860 @node Selection
3861 @section Selecting a frame
3862
3863 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3864 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3865 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3866 of the stack frame just selected.
3867
3868 @table @code
3869 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
3870 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
3871 @item frame @var{n}
3872 @itemx f @var{n}
3873 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3874 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3875 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3876 @code{main}.
3877
3878 @item frame @var{addr}
3879 @itemx f @var{addr}
3880 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3881 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3882 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3883 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3884 switches between them.
3885
3886 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3887 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3888
3889 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3890 pointer and a program counter.
3891
3892 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3893 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3894 @c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3895 @c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3896 @c as of 27 Jan 1994.
3897
3898 @kindex up
3899 @item up @var{n}
3900 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3901 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3902 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3903
3904 @kindex down
3905 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
3906 @item down @var{n}
3907 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3908 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3909 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3910 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3911 @end table
3912
3913 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3914 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3915 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
3916 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
3917
3918 @need 1000
3919 For example:
3920
3921 @smallexample
3922 @group
3923 (@value{GDBP}) up
3924 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3925 at env.c:10
3926 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3927 @end group
3928 @end smallexample
3929
3930 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3931 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3932 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
3933 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
3934 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
3935 for details.
3936
3937 @table @code
3938 @kindex down-silently
3939 @kindex up-silently
3940 @item up-silently @var{n}
3941 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
3942 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3943 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3944 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3945 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3946 distracting.
3947 @end table
3948
3949 @node Frame Info
3950 @section Information about a frame
3951
3952 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3953 stack frame.
3954
3955 @table @code
3956 @item frame
3957 @itemx f
3958 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3959 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3960 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3961 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3962 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3963
3964 @kindex info frame
3965 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
3966 @item info frame
3967 @itemx info f
3968 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3969 including:
3970
3971 @itemize @bullet
3972 @item
3973 the address of the frame
3974 @item
3975 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3976 @item
3977 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3978 @item
3979 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3980 @item
3981 the address of the frame's arguments
3982 @item
3983 the address of the frame's local variables
3984 @item
3985 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3986 @item
3987 which registers were saved in the frame
3988 @end itemize
3989
3990 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
3991 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3992 the usual conventions.
3993
3994 @item info frame @var{addr}
3995 @itemx info f @var{addr}
3996 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3997 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3998 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3999 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4000 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4001
4002 @kindex info args
4003 @item info args
4004 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4005
4006 @item info locals
4007 @kindex info locals
4008 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4009 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4010 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4011
4012 @kindex info catch
4013 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4014 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4015 @item info catch
4016 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4017 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4018 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4019 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4020 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
4021
4022 @end table
4023
4024
4025 @node Source
4026 @chapter Examining Source Files
4027
4028 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4029 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4030 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4031 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4032 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4033 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4034 source files by explicit command.
4035
4036 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4037 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4038 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4039
4040 @menu
4041 * List:: Printing source lines
4042 * Edit:: Editing source files
4043 * Search:: Searching source files
4044 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4045 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4046 @end menu
4047
4048 @node List
4049 @section Printing source lines
4050
4051 @kindex list
4052 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4053 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4054 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4055 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4056
4057 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4058
4059 @table @code
4060 @item list @var{linenum}
4061 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4062 current source file.
4063
4064 @item list @var{function}
4065 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4066 @var{function}.
4067
4068 @item list
4069 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4070 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4071 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4072 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4073 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4074
4075 @item list -
4076 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4077 @end table
4078
4079 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4080 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4081
4082 @table @code
4083 @kindex set listsize
4084 @item set listsize @var{count}
4085 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4086 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4087
4088 @kindex show listsize
4089 @item show listsize
4090 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4091 @end table
4092
4093 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4094 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4095 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4096 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4097 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4098
4099 @cindex linespec
4100 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4101 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4102 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4103 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4104
4105 @table @code
4106 @item list @var{linespec}
4107 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4108
4109 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4110 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4111 linespecs.
4112
4113 @item list ,@var{last}
4114 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4115
4116 @item list @var{first},
4117 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4118
4119 @item list +
4120 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4121
4122 @item list -
4123 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4124
4125 @item list
4126 As described in the preceding table.
4127 @end table
4128
4129 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4130 kinds of linespec.
4131
4132 @table @code
4133 @item @var{number}
4134 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4135 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4136 the same source file as the first linespec.
4137
4138 @item +@var{offset}
4139 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4140 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4141 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4142 first linespec.
4143
4144 @item -@var{offset}
4145 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4146
4147 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4148 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4149
4150 @item @var{function}
4151 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4152 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4153
4154 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4155 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4156 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4157 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4158 identically named functions in different source files.
4159
4160 @item *@var{address}
4161 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4162 @var{address} may be any expression.
4163 @end table
4164
4165 @node Edit
4166 @section Editing source files
4167 @cindex editing source files
4168
4169 @kindex edit
4170 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4171 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4172 The editing program of your choice
4173 is invoked with the current line set to
4174 the active line in the program.
4175 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4176 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4177
4178 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4179
4180 @table @code
4181 @item edit
4182 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4183
4184 @item edit @var{number}
4185 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4186
4187 @item edit @var{function}
4188 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4189
4190 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4191 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4192
4193 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4194 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4195 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4196 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4197 identically named functions in different source files.
4198
4199 @item edit *@var{address}
4200 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4201 @var{address} may be any expression.
4202 @end table
4203
4204 @subsection Choosing your editor
4205 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4206 @footnote{
4207 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4208 following command-line syntax:
4209 @smallexample
4210 ex +@var{number} file
4211 @end smallexample
4212 The optional numeric value +@var{number} designates the active line in
4213 the file.}. By default, it is @value{EDITOR}, but you can change this
4214 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4215 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4216 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4217 @smallexample
4218 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4219 export EDITOR
4220 gdb ...
4221 @end smallexample
4222 or in the @code{csh} shell,
4223 @smallexample
4224 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4225 gdb ...
4226 @end smallexample
4227
4228 @node Search
4229 @section Searching source files
4230 @cindex searching
4231 @kindex reverse-search
4232
4233 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4234 regular expression.
4235
4236 @table @code
4237 @kindex search
4238 @kindex forward-search
4239 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
4240 @itemx search @var{regexp}
4241 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4242 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
4243 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
4244 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4245 @code{fo}.
4246
4247 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4248 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4249 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4250 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4251 this command as @code{rev}.
4252 @end table
4253
4254 @node Source Path
4255 @section Specifying source directories
4256
4257 @cindex source path
4258 @cindex directories for source files
4259 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4260 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4261 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4262 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4263 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4264 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4265 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4266 the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4267 the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4268 path.
4269
4270 If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4271 object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4272 too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4273 compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4274 last resort.
4275
4276 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4277 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4278 each line is in the file.
4279
4280 @kindex directory
4281 @kindex dir
4282 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4283 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
4284 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4285
4286 @table @code
4287 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4288 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4289 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
4290 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4291 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4292 part of absolute file names) or
4293 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4294 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4295
4296 @kindex cdir
4297 @kindex cwd
4298 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4299 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
4300 @cindex compilation directory
4301 @cindex current directory
4302 @cindex working directory
4303 @cindex directory, current
4304 @cindex directory, compilation
4305 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4306 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4307 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4308 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4309 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4310 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4311
4312 @item directory
4313 Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4314
4315 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4316 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4317
4318 @item show directories
4319 @kindex show directories
4320 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4321 @end table
4322
4323 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4324 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4325 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4326
4327 @enumerate
4328 @item
4329 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4330
4331 @item
4332 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4333 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4334 directories in one command.
4335 @end enumerate
4336
4337 @node Machine Code
4338 @section Source and machine code
4339
4340 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4341 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4342 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
4343 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
4344 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
4345 well as hex.
4346
4347 @table @code
4348 @kindex info line
4349 @item info line @var{linespec}
4350 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4351 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4352 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4353 source lines}).
4354 @end table
4355
4356 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4357 the object code for the first line of function
4358 @code{m4_changequote}:
4359
4360 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4361 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
4362 @smallexample
4363 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
4364 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4365 @end smallexample
4366
4367 @noindent
4368 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4369 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4370 @smallexample
4371 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4372 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4373 @end smallexample
4374
4375 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
4376 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
4377 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4378 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4379 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4380 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4381 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4382 variables}).
4383
4384 @table @code
4385 @kindex disassemble
4386 @cindex assembly instructions
4387 @cindex instructions, assembly
4388 @cindex machine instructions
4389 @cindex listing machine instructions
4390 @item disassemble
4391 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4392 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4393 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4394 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4395 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4396 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4397 @end table
4398
4399 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4400 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4401
4402 @smallexample
4403 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4404 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
4405 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
4406 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
4407 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4408 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
4409 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
4410 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
4411 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
4412 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4413 End of assembler dump.
4414 @end smallexample
4415
4416 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4417 mnemonics or other syntax.
4418
4419 @table @code
4420 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
4421 @cindex assembly instructions
4422 @cindex instructions, assembly
4423 @cindex machine instructions
4424 @cindex listing machine instructions
4425 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4426 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4427 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
4428 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4429 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4430
4431 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
4432 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4433 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4434 assemblers for x86-based targets.
4435 @end table
4436
4437
4438 @node Data
4439 @chapter Examining Data
4440
4441 @cindex printing data
4442 @cindex examining data
4443 @kindex print
4444 @kindex inspect
4445 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4446 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4447 @c different window or something like that.
4448 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
4449 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4450 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4451 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4452 Different Languages}).
4453
4454 @table @code
4455 @item print @var{expr}
4456 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4457 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4458 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
4459 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
4460 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
4461 formats}.
4462
4463 @item print
4464 @itemx print /@var{f}
4465 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
4466 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4467 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4468 @end table
4469
4470 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4471 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4472 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4473
4474 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
4475 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4476 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
4477 Table}.
4478
4479 @menu
4480 * Expressions:: Expressions
4481 * Variables:: Program variables
4482 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4483 * Output Formats:: Output formats
4484 * Memory:: Examining memory
4485 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
4486 * Print Settings:: Print settings
4487 * Value History:: Value history
4488 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4489 * Registers:: Registers
4490 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
4491 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
4492 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
4493 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
4494 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
4495 character set than GDB does
4496 @end menu
4497
4498 @node Expressions
4499 @section Expressions
4500
4501 @cindex expressions
4502 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4503 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4504 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4505 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
4506 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
4507 you compiled your program to include this information; see
4508 @ref{Compilation}.
4509
4510 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4511 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
4512 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
4513 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
4514
4515 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4516 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4517 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4518 languages.
4519
4520 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4521 expressions regardless of your programming language.
4522
4523 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4524 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4525 at that address in memory.
4526 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
4527
4528 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4529 to programming languages:
4530
4531 @table @code
4532 @item @@
4533 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4534 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4535
4536 @item ::
4537 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4538 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4539
4540 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
4541 @cindex type casting memory
4542 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4543 @cindex casts, to view memory
4544 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4545 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4546 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4547 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4548 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4549 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4550 @end table
4551
4552 @node Variables
4553 @section Program variables
4554
4555 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4556 in your program.
4557
4558 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4559 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4560
4561 @itemize @bullet
4562 @item
4563 global (or file-static)
4564 @end itemize
4565
4566 @noindent or
4567
4568 @itemize @bullet
4569 @item
4570 visible according to the scope rules of the
4571 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
4572 @end itemize
4573
4574 @noindent This means that in the function
4575
4576 @smallexample
4577 foo (a)
4578 int a;
4579 @{
4580 bar (a);
4581 @{
4582 int b = test ();
4583 bar (b);
4584 @}
4585 @}
4586 @end smallexample
4587
4588 @noindent
4589 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4590 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4591 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4592 the block where @code{b} is declared.
4593
4594 @cindex variable name conflict
4595 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4596 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4597 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4598 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4599 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4600 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4601 using the colon-colon notation:
4602
4603 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
4604 @iftex
4605 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
4606 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
4607 @end iftex
4608 @smallexample
4609 @var{file}::@var{variable}
4610 @var{function}::@var{variable}
4611 @end smallexample
4612
4613 @noindent
4614 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4615 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4616 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4617 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4618
4619 @smallexample
4620 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4621 @end smallexample
4622
4623 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
4624 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4625 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
4626 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4627 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4628 @c conflict?? --mew
4629
4630 @cindex wrong values
4631 @cindex variable values, wrong
4632 @quotation
4633 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4634 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4635 scope, and just before exit.
4636 @end quotation
4637 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4638 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4639 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4640 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4641 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4642 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4643 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4644 variable definitions may be gone.
4645
4646 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4647 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4648 when compiling.
4649
4650 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4651 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4652 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4653 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4654 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4655 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4656 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4657
4658 @smallexample
4659 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4660 @end smallexample
4661
4662 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4663 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4664 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
4665 supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4666 in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
4667 to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
4668 debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4669 Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4670 information.
4671
4672
4673 @node Arrays
4674 @section Artificial arrays
4675
4676 @cindex artificial array
4677 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
4678 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4679 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4680 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4681 program.
4682
4683 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4684 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4685 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4686 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4687 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4688 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4689 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4690 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4691 example. If a program says
4692
4693 @smallexample
4694 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4695 @end smallexample
4696
4697 @noindent
4698 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4699
4700 @smallexample
4701 p *array@@len
4702 @end smallexample
4703
4704 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4705 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4706 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4707 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4708 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4709
4710 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4711 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4712 The value need not be in memory:
4713 @smallexample
4714 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4715 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4716 @end smallexample
4717
4718 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
4719 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
4720 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4721 @smallexample
4722 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4723 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4724 @end smallexample
4725
4726 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4727 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4728 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4729 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4730 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4731 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4732 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4733 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4734 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4735 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4736
4737 @smallexample
4738 set $i = 0
4739 p dtab[$i++]->fv
4740 @key{RET}
4741 @key{RET}
4742 @dots{}
4743 @end smallexample
4744
4745 @node Output Formats
4746 @section Output formats
4747
4748 @cindex formatted output
4749 @cindex output formats
4750 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4751 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4752 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4753 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4754 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4755
4756 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4757 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4758 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4759 letters supported are:
4760
4761 @table @code
4762 @item x
4763 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4764 hexadecimal.
4765
4766 @item d
4767 Print as integer in signed decimal.
4768
4769 @item u
4770 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4771
4772 @item o
4773 Print as integer in octal.
4774
4775 @item t
4776 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4777 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4778 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
4779 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
4780
4781 @item a
4782 @cindex unknown address, locating
4783 @cindex locate address
4784 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4785 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4786 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4787
4788 @smallexample
4789 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4790 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4791 @end smallexample
4792
4793 @noindent
4794 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4795 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4796
4797 @item c
4798 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4799
4800 @item f
4801 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4802 using typical floating point syntax.
4803 @end table
4804
4805 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4806
4807 @smallexample
4808 p/x $pc
4809 @end smallexample
4810
4811 @noindent
4812 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4813 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4814
4815 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4816 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4817 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4818
4819 @node Memory
4820 @section Examining memory
4821
4822 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4823 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4824
4825 @cindex examining memory
4826 @table @code
4827 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
4828 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4829 @itemx x @var{addr}
4830 @itemx x
4831 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4832 @end table
4833
4834 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4835 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4836 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4837 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4838 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4839
4840 @table @r
4841 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
4842 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4843 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4844 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4845 @c 4.1.2.
4846
4847 @item @var{f}, the display format
4848 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4849 @samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4850 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4851 The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4852
4853 @item @var{u}, the unit size
4854 The unit size is any of
4855
4856 @table @code
4857 @item b
4858 Bytes.
4859 @item h
4860 Halfwords (two bytes).
4861 @item w
4862 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4863 @item g
4864 Giant words (eight bytes).
4865 @end table
4866
4867 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4868 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4869 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4870
4871 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
4872 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4873 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4874 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4875 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4876 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4877 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4878 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4879 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4880 a value from memory).
4881 @end table
4882
4883 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4884 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4885 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4886 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
4887 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
4888
4889 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4890 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4891 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4892 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4893 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4894
4895 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4896 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4897 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4898 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
4899 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
4900 Code,,Source and machine code}.
4901
4902 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4903 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4904 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4905 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4906 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4907 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4908 for successive uses of @code{x}.
4909
4910 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4911 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4912 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4913 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4914 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4915 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4916 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4917 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4918 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4919
4920 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4921 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4922 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4923
4924 @node Auto Display
4925 @section Automatic display
4926 @cindex automatic display
4927 @cindex display of expressions
4928
4929 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4930 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4931 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4932 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4933 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4934 The automatic display looks like this:
4935
4936 @smallexample
4937 2: foo = 38
4938 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4939 @end smallexample
4940
4941 @noindent
4942 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4943 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4944 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4945 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4946 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4947 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4948 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4949
4950 @table @code
4951 @kindex display
4952 @item display @var{expr}
4953 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
4954 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4955
4956 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4957
4958 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
4959 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
4960 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
4961 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4962 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4963
4964 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4965 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4966 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4967 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4968 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4969 @end table
4970
4971 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4972 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
4973 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
4974
4975 @table @code
4976 @kindex delete display
4977 @kindex undisplay
4978 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4979 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4980 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4981
4982 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4983 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4984
4985 @kindex disable display
4986 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4987 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4988 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4989 enabled again later.
4990
4991 @kindex enable display
4992 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4993 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4994 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4995
4996 @item display
4997 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4998 done when your program stops.
4999
5000 @kindex info display
5001 @item info display
5002 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5003 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5004 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5005 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5006 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5007 @end table
5008
5009 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5010 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5011 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5012 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5013 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5014 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5015 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5016 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5017 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5018 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5019
5020 @node Print Settings
5021 @section Print settings
5022
5023 @cindex format options
5024 @cindex print settings
5025 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5026 and symbols are printed.
5027
5028 @noindent
5029 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5030
5031 @table @code
5032 @kindex set print address
5033 @item set print address
5034 @itemx set print address on
5035 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5036 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5037 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5038 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5039 @code{set print address on}:
5040
5041 @smallexample
5042 @group
5043 (@value{GDBP}) f
5044 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5045 at input.c:530
5046 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5047 @end group
5048 @end smallexample
5049
5050 @item set print address off
5051 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5052 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5053
5054 @smallexample
5055 @group
5056 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5057 (@value{GDBP}) f
5058 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5059 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5060 @end group
5061 @end smallexample
5062
5063 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5064 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5065 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5066 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5067
5068 @kindex show print address
5069 @item show print address
5070 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5071 @end table
5072
5073 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5074 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5075 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5076 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5077 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5078 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5079 it prints a symbolic address:
5080
5081 @table @code
5082 @kindex set print symbol-filename
5083 @item set print symbol-filename on
5084 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5085 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5086
5087 @item set print symbol-filename off
5088 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5089 default.
5090
5091 @kindex show print symbol-filename
5092 @item show print symbol-filename
5093 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5094 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5095 @end table
5096
5097 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5098 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5099 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5100
5101 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5102 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5103
5104 @table @code
5105 @kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5106 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5107 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5108 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5109 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
5110 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5111
5112 @kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5113 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
5114 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5115 symbolic address.
5116 @end table
5117
5118 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5119 @cindex pointer, finding referent
5120 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5121 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5122 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5123 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5124 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5125 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5126
5127 @smallexample
5128 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5129 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5130 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
5131 @end smallexample
5132
5133 @quotation
5134 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5135 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5136 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5137 @end quotation
5138
5139 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5140
5141 @table @code
5142 @kindex set print array
5143 @item set print array
5144 @itemx set print array on
5145 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5146 but uses more space. The default is off.
5147
5148 @item set print array off
5149 Return to compressed format for arrays.
5150
5151 @kindex show print array
5152 @item show print array
5153 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5154 arrays.
5155
5156 @kindex set print elements
5157 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5158 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5159 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5160 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5161 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
5162 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
5163 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5164
5165 @kindex show print elements
5166 @item show print elements
5167 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5168 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5169
5170 @kindex set print null-stop
5171 @item set print null-stop
5172 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
5173 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
5174 contain only short strings.
5175 The default is off.
5176
5177 @kindex set print pretty
5178 @item set print pretty on
5179 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
5180 per line, like this:
5181
5182 @smallexample
5183 @group
5184 $1 = @{
5185 next = 0x0,
5186 flags = @{
5187 sweet = 1,
5188 sour = 1
5189 @},
5190 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5191 @}
5192 @end group
5193 @end smallexample
5194
5195 @item set print pretty off
5196 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5197
5198 @smallexample
5199 @group
5200 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5201 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5202 @end group
5203 @end smallexample
5204
5205 @noindent
5206 This is the default format.
5207
5208 @kindex show print pretty
5209 @item show print pretty
5210 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5211
5212 @kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5213 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
5214 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5215 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5216 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5217 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5218 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5219
5220 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
5221 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5222 international character sets, and is the default.
5223
5224 @kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5225 @item show print sevenbit-strings
5226 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5227
5228 @kindex set print union
5229 @item set print union on
5230 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
5231 is the default setting.
5232
5233 @item set print union off
5234 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5235
5236 @kindex show print union
5237 @item show print union
5238 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5239 structures.
5240
5241 For example, given the declarations
5242
5243 @smallexample
5244 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5245 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5246 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
5247 Bug_forms;
5248
5249 struct thing @{
5250 Species it;
5251 union @{
5252 Tree_forms tree;
5253 Bug_forms bug;
5254 @} form;
5255 @};
5256
5257 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5258 @end smallexample
5259
5260 @noindent
5261 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5262
5263 @smallexample
5264 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5265 @end smallexample
5266
5267 @noindent
5268 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5269
5270 @smallexample
5271 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5272 @end smallexample
5273 @end table
5274
5275 @need 1000
5276 @noindent
5277 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
5278
5279 @table @code
5280 @cindex demangling
5281 @kindex set print demangle
5282 @item set print demangle
5283 @itemx set print demangle on
5284 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5285 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
5286 linkage. The default is on.
5287
5288 @kindex show print demangle
5289 @item show print demangle
5290 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5291
5292 @kindex set print asm-demangle
5293 @item set print asm-demangle
5294 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
5295 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5296 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5297 The default is off.
5298
5299 @kindex show print asm-demangle
5300 @item show print asm-demangle
5301 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5302 or demangled form.
5303
5304 @kindex set demangle-style
5305 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5306 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
5307 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
5308 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5309 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5310
5311 @table @code
5312 @item auto
5313 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5314
5315 @item gnu
5316 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
5317 This is the default.
5318
5319 @item hp
5320 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5321
5322 @item lucid
5323 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5324
5325 @item arm
5326 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
5327 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5328 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5329 require further enhancement to permit that.
5330
5331 @end table
5332 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5333
5334 @kindex show demangle-style
5335 @item show demangle-style
5336 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
5337
5338 @kindex set print object
5339 @item set print object
5340 @itemx set print object on
5341 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5342 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5343 the virtual function table.
5344
5345 @item set print object off
5346 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5347 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5348
5349 @kindex show print object
5350 @item show print object
5351 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5352
5353 @kindex set print static-members
5354 @item set print static-members
5355 @itemx set print static-members on
5356 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
5357
5358 @item set print static-members off
5359 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
5360
5361 @kindex show print static-members
5362 @item show print static-members
5363 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
5364
5365 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5366 @kindex set print vtbl
5367 @item set print vtbl
5368 @itemx set print vtbl on
5369 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
5370 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
5371 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
5372
5373 @item set print vtbl off
5374 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
5375
5376 @kindex show print vtbl
5377 @item show print vtbl
5378 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5379 @end table
5380
5381 @node Value History
5382 @section Value history
5383
5384 @cindex value history
5385 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5386 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5387 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5388 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5389 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5390 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
5391 symbol table.
5392
5393 @cindex @code{$}
5394 @cindex @code{$$}
5395 @cindex history number
5396 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5397 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5398 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5399 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5400 history number.
5401
5402 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5403 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5404 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5405 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5406 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5407 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5408 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5409
5410 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5411 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5412
5413 @smallexample
5414 p *$
5415 @end smallexample
5416
5417 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5418 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5419
5420 @smallexample
5421 p *$.next
5422 @end smallexample
5423
5424 @noindent
5425 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5426 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5427
5428 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5429 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5430
5431 @smallexample
5432 print x
5433 set x=5
5434 @end smallexample
5435
5436 @noindent
5437 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5438 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5439
5440 @table @code
5441 @kindex show values
5442 @item show values
5443 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5444 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5445 values} does not change the history.
5446
5447 @item show values @var{n}
5448 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5449
5450 @item show values +
5451 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5452 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5453 @end table
5454
5455 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5456 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5457
5458 @node Convenience Vars
5459 @section Convenience variables
5460
5461 @cindex convenience variables
5462 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5463 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5464 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5465 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5466 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5467
5468 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5469 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
5470 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5471 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5472 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5473
5474 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5475 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5476 For example:
5477
5478 @smallexample
5479 set $foo = *object_ptr
5480 @end smallexample
5481
5482 @noindent
5483 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5484 @code{object_ptr}.
5485
5486 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5487 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5488 value with another assignment at any time.
5489
5490 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5491 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5492 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5493 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5494
5495 @table @code
5496 @kindex show convenience
5497 @item show convenience
5498 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
5499 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
5500 @end table
5501
5502 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5503 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5504 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5505
5506 @smallexample
5507 set $i = 0
5508 print bar[$i++]->contents
5509 @end smallexample
5510
5511 @noindent
5512 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
5513
5514 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5515 values likely to be useful.
5516
5517 @table @code
5518 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
5519 @item $_
5520 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5521 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5522 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5523 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5524 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5525 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5526 to the type of @code{$__}.
5527
5528 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
5529 @item $__
5530 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5531 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5532 to match the format in which the data was printed.
5533
5534 @item $_exitcode
5535 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
5536 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5537 the program being debugged terminates.
5538 @end table
5539
5540 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5541 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5542 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
5543
5544 @node Registers
5545 @section Registers
5546
5547 @cindex registers
5548 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5549 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5550 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5551 your machine.
5552
5553 @table @code
5554 @kindex info registers
5555 @item info registers
5556 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5557 registers (in the selected stack frame).
5558
5559 @kindex info all-registers
5560 @cindex floating point registers
5561 @item info all-registers
5562 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5563 registers.
5564
5565 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5566 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5567 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5568 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
5569 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5570 @end table
5571
5572 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5573 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5574 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5575 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5576 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5577 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5578 register that contains the processor status. For example,
5579 you could print the program counter in hex with
5580
5581 @smallexample
5582 p/x $pc
5583 @end smallexample
5584
5585 @noindent
5586 or print the instruction to be executed next with
5587
5588 @smallexample
5589 x/i $pc
5590 @end smallexample
5591
5592 @noindent
5593 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5594 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5595 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5596 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5597 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5598 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
5599 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
5600
5601 @smallexample
5602 set $sp += 4
5603 @end smallexample
5604
5605 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5606 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5607 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5608 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5609 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
5610 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5611 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
5612
5613 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5614 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5615 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5616 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5617 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5618 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5619 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5620
5621 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5622 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5623 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5624 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5625 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5626 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5627 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
5628 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5629 prints the data in both formats.
5630
5631 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5632 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5633 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5634 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5635 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5636 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5637
5638 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5639 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5640 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5641 frame makes no difference.
5642
5643 @node Floating Point Hardware
5644 @section Floating point hardware
5645 @cindex floating point
5646
5647 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5648 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5649
5650 @table @code
5651 @kindex info float
5652 @item info float
5653 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5654 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5655 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5656 the ARM and x86 machines.
5657 @end table
5658
5659 @node Vector Unit
5660 @section Vector Unit
5661 @cindex vector unit
5662
5663 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
5664 more information about the status of the vector unit.
5665
5666 @table @code
5667 @kindex info vector
5668 @item info vector
5669 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
5670 layout vary depending on the hardware.
5671 @end table
5672
5673 @node Memory Region Attributes
5674 @section Memory region attributes
5675 @cindex memory region attributes
5676
5677 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5678 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5679 to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5680 use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5681
5682 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5683 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5684 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5685 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5686 all memory.
5687
5688 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5689 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5690
5691 @table @code
5692 @kindex mem
5693 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5694 Define memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
5695 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a
5696 special case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
5697 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
5698
5699 @kindex delete mem
5700 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5701 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5702
5703 @kindex disable mem
5704 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5705 Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5706 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5707 It may be enabled again later.
5708
5709 @kindex enable mem
5710 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5711 Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5712
5713 @kindex info mem
5714 @item info mem
5715 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5716 for each region.
5717
5718 @table @emph
5719 @item Memory Region Number
5720 @item Enabled or Disabled.
5721 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5722 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5723
5724 @item Lo Address
5725 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5726
5727 @item Hi Address
5728 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5729
5730 @item Attributes
5731 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5732 @end table
5733 @end table
5734
5735
5736 @subsection Attributes
5737
5738 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5739 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5740 write accesses to a memory region.
5741
5742 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5743 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5744 etc. from accessing memory.
5745
5746 @table @code
5747 @item ro
5748 Memory is read only.
5749 @item wo
5750 Memory is write only.
5751 @item rw
5752 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
5753 @end table
5754
5755 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
5756 The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5757 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5758 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5759 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5760
5761 @table @code
5762 @item 8
5763 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5764 @item 16
5765 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5766 @item 32
5767 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5768 @item 64
5769 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5770 @end table
5771
5772 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5773 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5774 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5775 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5776 @c
5777 @c @table @code
5778 @c @item hwbreak
5779 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
5780 @c @item swbreak (default)
5781 @c @end table
5782
5783 @subsubsection Data Cache
5784 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5785 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5786 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5787 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5788 registers.
5789
5790 @table @code
5791 @item cache
5792 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5793 @item nocache
5794 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
5795 @end table
5796
5797 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5798 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5799 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5800 @c
5801 @c @table @code
5802 @c @item verify
5803 @c @item noverify (default)
5804 @c @end table
5805
5806 @node Dump/Restore Files
5807 @section Copy between memory and a file
5808 @cindex dump/restore files
5809 @cindex append data to a file
5810 @cindex dump data to a file
5811 @cindex restore data from a file
5812 @kindex dump
5813 @kindex append
5814 @kindex restore
5815
5816 The commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and @code{restore} are used
5817 for copying data between target memory and a file. Data is written
5818 into a file using @code{dump} or @code{append}, and restored from a
5819 file into memory by using @code{restore}. Files may be binary, srec,
5820 intel hex, or tekhex (but only binary files can be appended).
5821
5822 @table @code
5823 @kindex dump binary
5824 @kindex append binary
5825 @item dump binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5826 Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5827 raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5828
5829 @item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5830 Append contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} to
5831 raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5832
5833 @item dump binary value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5834 Dump value of @var{expression} into raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5835
5836 @item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{expression}
5837 Append value of @var{expression} to raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5838
5839 @kindex dump ihex
5840 @item dump ihex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5841 Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5842 intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5843
5844 @item dump ihex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5845 Dump value of @var{expression} into intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5846
5847 @kindex dump srec
5848 @item dump srec memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5849 Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5850 srec format file @var{filename}.
5851
5852 @item dump srec value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5853 Dump value of @var{expression} into srec format file @var{filename}.
5854
5855 @kindex dump tekhex
5856 @item dump tekhex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5857 Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5858 tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5859
5860 @item dump tekhex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5861 Dump value of @var{expression} into tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5862
5863 @item restore @var{filename} [@var{binary}] @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
5864 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The @code{restore}
5865 command can automatically recognize any known bfd file format, except for
5866 raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you must use the optional argument
5867 @var{binary} after the filename.
5868
5869 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
5870 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
5871 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
5872 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
5873 from that location.
5874
5875 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
5876 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
5877 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
5878 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
5879
5880 @end table
5881
5882 @node Character Sets
5883 @section Character Sets
5884 @cindex character sets
5885 @cindex charset
5886 @cindex translating between character sets
5887 @cindex host character set
5888 @cindex target character set
5889
5890 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
5891 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
5892 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
5893 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
5894 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
5895 @dfn{target character set}.
5896
5897 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
5898 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
5899 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
5900 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
5901 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
5902 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
5903 target-charset ebcdic-us}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
5904 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
5905 character and string literals in expressions.
5906
5907 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
5908 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
5909 target-charset} command, described below.
5910
5911 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
5912 support:
5913
5914 @table @code
5915 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
5916 @kindex set target-charset
5917 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
5918 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you invoke the
5919 @code{set target-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists
5920 the character sets it supports.
5921 @end table
5922
5923 @table @code
5924 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
5925 @kindex set host-charset
5926 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
5927
5928 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
5929 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
5930 @code{set host-charset} command.
5931
5932 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
5933 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
5934 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you invoke the
5935 @code{set host-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists the
5936 character sets it supports, placing an asterisk (@samp{*}) after those
5937 it can use as a host character set.
5938
5939 @item set charset @var{charset}
5940 @kindex set charset
5941 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. If you
5942 invoke the @code{set charset} command with no argument, it lists the
5943 character sets it supports. @value{GDBN} can only use certain character
5944 sets as its host character set; it marks those in the list with an
5945 asterisk (@samp{*}).
5946
5947 @item show charset
5948 @itemx show host-charset
5949 @itemx show target-charset
5950 @kindex show charset
5951 @kindex show host-charset
5952 @kindex show target-charset
5953 Show the current host and target charsets. The @code{show host-charset}
5954 and @code{show target-charset} commands are synonyms for @code{show
5955 charset}.
5956
5957 @end table
5958
5959 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
5960 sets:
5961
5962 @table @code
5963
5964 @item ASCII
5965 @cindex ASCII character set
5966 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
5967 character set.
5968
5969 @item ISO-8859-1
5970 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
5971 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
5972 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends ASCII with accented
5973 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
5974 this as its host character set.
5975
5976 @item EBCDIC-US
5977 @itemx IBM1047
5978 @cindex EBCDIC character set
5979 @cindex IBM1047 character set
5980 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
5981 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
5982 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
5983
5984 @end table
5985
5986 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
5987 GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
5988 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
5989
5990 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
5991 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
5992 @file{charset-test.c}:
5993
5994 @smallexample
5995 #include <stdio.h>
5996
5997 char ascii_hello[]
5998 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
5999 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
6000 char ibm1047_hello[]
6001 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
6002 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
6003
6004 main ()
6005 @{
6006 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6007 @}
6008 @end smallexample
6009
6010 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
6011 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
6012 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
6013
6014 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
6015
6016 @smallexample
6017 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
6018 $ gdb -nw charset-test
6019 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
6020 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6021 @dots{}
6022 (gdb)
6023 @end smallexample
6024
6025 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
6026 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
6027 strings:
6028
6029 @smallexample
6030 (gdb) show charset
6031 The current host and target character set is `iso-8859-1'.
6032 (gdb)
6033 @end smallexample
6034
6035 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
6036 initial character set:
6037 @smallexample
6038 (gdb) set charset ascii
6039 (gdb) show charset
6040 The current host and target character set is `ascii'.
6041 (gdb)
6042 @end smallexample
6043
6044 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
6045 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
6046 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
6047 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
6048 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
6049
6050 @smallexample
6051 (gdb) print ascii_hello
6052 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
6053 (gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6054 $2 = 72 'H'
6055 (gdb)
6056 @end smallexample
6057
6058 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
6059 literals you use in expressions:
6060
6061 @smallexample
6062 (gdb) print '+'
6063 $3 = 43 '+'
6064 (gdb)
6065 @end smallexample
6066
6067 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
6068 character.
6069
6070 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
6071 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
6072 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
6073
6074 @smallexample
6075 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6076 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
6077 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6078 $5 = 200 '\310'
6079 (gdb)
6080 @end smallexample
6081
6082 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} command without an argument,
6083 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
6084
6085 @smallexample
6086 (gdb) set target-charset
6087 Valid character sets are:
6088 ascii *
6089 iso-8859-1 *
6090 ebcdic-us
6091 ibm1047
6092 * - can be used as a host character set
6093 @end smallexample
6094
6095 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
6096 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
6097 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
6098 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
6099 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
6100
6101 @smallexample
6102 (gdb) set target-charset ibm1047
6103 (gdb) show charset
6104 The current host character set is `ascii'.
6105 The current target character set is `ibm1047'.
6106 (gdb) print ascii_hello
6107 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
6108 (gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6109 $7 = 72 '\110'
6110 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6111 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
6112 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6113 $9 = 200 'H'
6114 (gdb)
6115 @end smallexample
6116
6117 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
6118 string literals you use in expressions:
6119
6120 @smallexample
6121 (gdb) print '+'
6122 $10 = 78 '+'
6123 (gdb)
6124 @end smallexample
6125
6126 The IBM1047 character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
6127 character.
6128
6129
6130 @node Macros
6131 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
6132
6133 Some languages, such as C and C++, provide a way to define and invoke
6134 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
6135 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
6136 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
6137 where it was defined.
6138
6139 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
6140 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
6141 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
6142 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
6143
6144 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
6145 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
6146 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
6147 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
6148 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
6149 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
6150 see @ref{List}.
6151
6152 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
6153 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
6154 variable-arity macros.
6155
6156 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
6157 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
6158 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
6159
6160 @table @code
6161
6162 @kindex macro expand
6163 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
6164 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
6165 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
6166 @item macro expand @var{expression}
6167 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
6168 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
6169 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
6170 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
6171 it can be any string of tokens.
6172
6173 @kindex macro expand-once
6174 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
6175 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
6176 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
6177 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
6178 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
6179 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
6180 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
6181 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
6182 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
6183 can be any string of tokens.
6184
6185 @kindex info macro
6186 @cindex macro definition, showing
6187 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
6188 @item info macro @var{macro}
6189 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
6190 source location where that definition was established.
6191
6192 @kindex macro define
6193 @cindex user-defined macros
6194 @cindex defining macros interactively
6195 @cindex macros, user-defined
6196 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
6197 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
6198 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
6199 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
6200 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
6201 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
6202 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
6203 given in @var{arglist}.
6204
6205 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
6206 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
6207 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
6208 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
6209 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
6210
6211 @kindex macro undef
6212 @item macro undef @var{macro}
6213 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
6214 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
6215 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
6216 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
6217 debugged.
6218
6219 @end table
6220
6221 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
6222 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
6223 show our source files:
6224
6225 @smallexample
6226 $ cat sample.c
6227 #include <stdio.h>
6228 #include "sample.h"
6229
6230 #define M 42
6231 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6232
6233 main ()
6234 @{
6235 #define N 28
6236 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6237 #undef N
6238 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6239 #define N 1729
6240 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6241 @}
6242 $ cat sample.h
6243 #define Q <
6244 $
6245 @end smallexample
6246
6247 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
6248 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
6249 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
6250 information.
6251
6252 @smallexample
6253 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
6254 $
6255 @end smallexample
6256
6257 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
6258
6259 @smallexample
6260 $ gdb -nw sample
6261 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
6262 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6263 GDB is free software, @dots{}
6264 (gdb)
6265 @end smallexample
6266
6267 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
6268 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
6269 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
6270
6271 @smallexample
6272 (gdb) list main
6273 3
6274 4 #define M 42
6275 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6276 6
6277 7 main ()
6278 8 @{
6279 9 #define N 28
6280 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6281 11 #undef N
6282 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6283 (gdb) info macro ADD
6284 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
6285 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6286 (gdb) info macro Q
6287 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
6288 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
6289 #define Q <
6290 (gdb) macro expand ADD(1)
6291 expands to: (42 + 1)
6292 (gdb) macro expand-once ADD(1)
6293 expands to: once (M + 1)
6294 (gdb)
6295 @end smallexample
6296
6297 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
6298 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
6299 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
6300 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
6301
6302 Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
6303 the source line of the current stack frame:
6304
6305 @smallexample
6306 (gdb) break main
6307 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
6308 (gdb) run
6309 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
6310
6311 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
6312 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6313 (gdb)
6314 @end smallexample
6315
6316 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
6317
6318 @smallexample
6319 (gdb) info macro N
6320 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
6321 #define N 28
6322 (gdb) macro expand N Q M
6323 expands to: 28 < 42
6324 (gdb) print N Q M
6325 $1 = 1
6326 (gdb)
6327 @end smallexample
6328
6329 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
6330 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
6331 thereof) in force at each point:
6332
6333 @smallexample
6334 (gdb) next
6335 Hello, world!
6336 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6337 (gdb) info macro N
6338 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
6339 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
6340 (gdb) next
6341 We're so creative.
6342 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6343 (gdb) info macro N
6344 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
6345 #define N 1729
6346 (gdb) macro expand N Q M
6347 expands to: 1729 < 42
6348 (gdb) print N Q M
6349 $2 = 0
6350 (gdb)
6351 @end smallexample
6352
6353
6354 @node Tracepoints
6355 @chapter Tracepoints
6356 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
6357 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
6358
6359 @cindex tracepoints
6360 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
6361 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
6362 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
6363 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
6364 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
6365 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
6366 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
6367
6368 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
6369 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
6370 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
6371 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
6372 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
6373 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
6374 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
6375 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
6376 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
6377 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
6378 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
6379
6380 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
6381 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
6382 to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
6383 stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
6384 tracepoints as of this writing.
6385
6386 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
6387
6388 @menu
6389 * Set Tracepoints::
6390 * Analyze Collected Data::
6391 * Tracepoint Variables::
6392 @end menu
6393
6394 @node Set Tracepoints
6395 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
6396
6397 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
6398 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
6399 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
6400 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
6401 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
6402 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
6403 work on.
6404
6405 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
6406 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
6407 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
6408 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
6409 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
6410 tracepoint was hit.
6411
6412 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
6413 conditions and actions.
6414
6415 @menu
6416 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
6417 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
6418 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
6419 * Tracepoint Actions::
6420 * Listing Tracepoints::
6421 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
6422 @end menu
6423
6424 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
6425 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
6426
6427 @table @code
6428 @cindex set tracepoint
6429 @kindex trace
6430 @item trace
6431 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
6432 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
6433 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
6434 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
6435 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
6436 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
6437 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
6438 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
6439 running.
6440
6441 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
6442
6443 @smallexample
6444 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
6445
6446 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
6447
6448 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
6449
6450 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
6451
6452 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
6453 @end smallexample
6454
6455 @noindent
6456 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
6457
6458 @vindex $tpnum
6459 @cindex last tracepoint number
6460 @cindex recent tracepoint number
6461 @cindex tracepoint number
6462 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
6463 of the most recently set tracepoint.
6464
6465 @kindex delete tracepoint
6466 @cindex tracepoint deletion
6467 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6468 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
6469 default is to delete all tracepoints.
6470
6471 Examples:
6472
6473 @smallexample
6474 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
6475
6476 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
6477 @end smallexample
6478
6479 @noindent
6480 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
6481 @end table
6482
6483 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6484 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6485
6486 @table @code
6487 @kindex disable tracepoint
6488 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6489 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
6490 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
6491 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
6492 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
6493
6494 @kindex enable tracepoint
6495 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6496 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
6497 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
6498 run.
6499 @end table
6500
6501 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
6502 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
6503
6504 @table @code
6505 @kindex passcount
6506 @cindex tracepoint pass count
6507 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
6508 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
6509 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
6510 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
6511 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
6512 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
6513 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
6514 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
6515 user.
6516
6517 Examples:
6518
6519 @smallexample
6520 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
6521 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
6522
6523 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
6524 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
6525 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6526 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
6527 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
6528 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
6529 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
6530 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
6531 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
6532 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
6533 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
6534 @end smallexample
6535 @end table
6536
6537 @node Tracepoint Actions
6538 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
6539
6540 @table @code
6541 @kindex actions
6542 @cindex tracepoint actions
6543 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6544 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
6545 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
6546 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
6547 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
6548 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
6549 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
6550 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
6551 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
6552 @code{while-stepping}.
6553
6554 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
6555 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
6556 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
6557
6558 @smallexample
6559 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
6560
6561 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
6562
6563 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
6564 @end smallexample
6565
6566 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
6567 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
6568 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
6569 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
6570 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
6571 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
6572 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
6573 @code{end} command.
6574
6575 @smallexample
6576 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6577 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6578 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
6579 > collect bar,baz
6580 > collect $regs
6581 > while-stepping 12
6582 > collect $fp, $sp
6583 > end
6584 end
6585 @end smallexample
6586
6587 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6588 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6589 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6590 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6591 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6592 special arguments are supported:
6593
6594 @table @code
6595 @item $regs
6596 collect all registers
6597
6598 @item $args
6599 collect all function arguments
6600
6601 @item $locals
6602 collect all local variables.
6603 @end table
6604
6605 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6606 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6607 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6608
6609 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6610 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6611
6612 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6613 @item while-stepping @var{n}
6614 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6615 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6616 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6617 its own @code{end} command):
6618
6619 @smallexample
6620 > while-stepping 12
6621 > collect $regs, myglobal
6622 > end
6623 >
6624 @end smallexample
6625
6626 @noindent
6627 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6628 @code{stepping}.
6629 @end table
6630
6631 @node Listing Tracepoints
6632 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
6633
6634 @table @code
6635 @kindex info tracepoints
6636 @cindex information about tracepoints
6637 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6638 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
6639 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
6640 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6641 shown:
6642
6643 @itemize @bullet
6644 @item
6645 its number
6646 @item
6647 whether it is enabled or disabled
6648 @item
6649 its address
6650 @item
6651 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6652 @item
6653 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6654 @item
6655 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6656 @item
6657 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6658 @end itemize
6659
6660 @smallexample
6661 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6662 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
6663 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6664 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
6665 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
6666 (@value{GDBP})
6667 @end smallexample
6668
6669 @noindent
6670 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6671 @end table
6672
6673 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6674 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6675
6676 @table @code
6677 @kindex tstart
6678 @cindex start a new trace experiment
6679 @cindex collected data discarded
6680 @item tstart
6681 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6682 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6683 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6684 experiment.
6685
6686 @kindex tstop
6687 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
6688 @item tstop
6689 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6690 stops collecting data.
6691
6692 @strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6693 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6694 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6695
6696 @kindex tstatus
6697 @cindex status of trace data collection
6698 @cindex trace experiment, status of
6699 @item tstatus
6700 This command displays the status of the current trace data
6701 collection.
6702 @end table
6703
6704 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6705
6706 @smallexample
6707 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6709 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6710 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
6711 > while-stepping 11
6712 > collect $regs
6713 > end
6714 > end
6715 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6716 [time passes @dots{}]
6717 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6718 @end smallexample
6719
6720
6721 @node Analyze Collected Data
6722 @section Using the collected data
6723
6724 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6725 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6726 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6727 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6728 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6729 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6730 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6731 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6732 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6733 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6734 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6735 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6736 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6737 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6738 the buffer will fail.
6739
6740 @menu
6741 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6742 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6743 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6744 @end menu
6745
6746 @node tfind
6747 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6748
6749 @kindex tfind
6750 @cindex select trace snapshot
6751 @cindex find trace snapshot
6752 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6753 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6754 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6755 snapshot is selected.
6756
6757 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6758
6759 @table @code
6760 @item tfind start
6761 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6762 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6763
6764 @item tfind none
6765 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6766
6767 @item tfind end
6768 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6769
6770 @item tfind
6771 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6772
6773 @item tfind -
6774 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6775 retracing earlier steps.
6776
6777 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6778 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6779 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6780 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6781 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6782
6783 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
6784 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6785 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6786 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6787 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6788
6789 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6790 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6791 addresses.
6792
6793 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6794 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6795 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6796
6797 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6798 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6799 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6800 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6801 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6802 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6803 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6804 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6805 @end table
6806
6807 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6808 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6809 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6810 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6811 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6812 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6813 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6814 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6815 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6816 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6817 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6818 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6819 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6820 tracepoint as the current one.
6821
6822 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6823 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6824 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6825 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6826 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6827
6828 @smallexample
6829 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6830 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6831 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6832 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6833 > tfind
6834 > end
6835
6836 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6837 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6838 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6839 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6840 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6841 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6842 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6843 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6844 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6845 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6846 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6847 @end smallexample
6848
6849 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6850 the buffer:
6851
6852 @smallexample
6853 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6854 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6855 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6856 > tfind line
6857 > end
6858
6859 Frame 0, X = 1
6860 Frame 7, X = 2
6861 Frame 13, X = 255
6862 @end smallexample
6863
6864 @node tdump
6865 @subsection @code{tdump}
6866 @kindex tdump
6867 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6868 @cindex tracepoint data, display
6869
6870 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6871 the current trace snapshot.
6872
6873 @smallexample
6874 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6875 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6876 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6877 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6878 > end
6879
6880 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6881
6882 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6883 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6884 at gdb_test.c:444
6885 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6886
6887 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6888 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6889 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6890 d1 0x18 24
6891 d2 0x80 128
6892 d3 0x33 51
6893 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6894 d5 0x22 34
6895 d6 0xe0 224
6896 d7 0x380035 3670069
6897 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6898 a1 0x3000668 50333288
6899 a2 0x100 256
6900 a3 0x322000 3284992
6901 a4 0x3000698 50333336
6902 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6903 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6904 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6905 ps 0x0 0
6906 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6907 fpcontrol 0x0 0
6908 fpstatus 0x0 0
6909 fpiaddr 0x0 0
6910 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6911 p1 = (void *) 0x11
6912 p2 = (void *) 0x22
6913 p3 = (void *) 0x33
6914 p4 = (void *) 0x44
6915 p5 = (void *) 0x55
6916 p6 = (void *) 0x66
6917 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6918
6919 (@value{GDBP})
6920 @end smallexample
6921
6922 @node save-tracepoints
6923 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6924 @kindex save-tracepoints
6925 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6926
6927 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6928 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6929 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6930 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6931 Files}).
6932
6933 @node Tracepoint Variables
6934 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6935 @cindex tracepoint variables
6936 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6937
6938 @table @code
6939 @vindex $trace_frame
6940 @item (int) $trace_frame
6941 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6942 snapshot is selected.
6943
6944 @vindex $tracepoint
6945 @item (int) $tracepoint
6946 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6947
6948 @vindex $trace_line
6949 @item (int) $trace_line
6950 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6951
6952 @vindex $trace_file
6953 @item (char []) $trace_file
6954 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6955
6956 @vindex $trace_func
6957 @item (char []) $trace_func
6958 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6959 @end table
6960
6961 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6962 use @code{output} instead.
6963
6964 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6965 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6966 data.
6967
6968 @smallexample
6969 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6970
6971 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6972 > output $trace_file
6973 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6974 > tfind
6975 > end
6976 @end smallexample
6977
6978 @node Overlays
6979 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
6980 @cindex overlays
6981
6982 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
6983 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
6984 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
6985 use overlays.
6986
6987 @menu
6988 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
6989 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
6990 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
6991 mapped by asking the inferior.
6992 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
6993 @end menu
6994
6995 @node How Overlays Work
6996 @section How Overlays Work
6997 @cindex mapped overlays
6998 @cindex unmapped overlays
6999 @cindex load address, overlay's
7000 @cindex mapped address
7001 @cindex overlay area
7002
7003 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
7004 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
7005 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
7006 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
7007 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
7008
7009 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
7010 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
7011 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
7012 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
7013 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
7014 largest overlay as well.
7015
7016 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
7017 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
7018 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
7019 there.
7020
7021 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
7022 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
7023 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
7024
7025 @smallexample
7026 @group
7027 Data Instruction Larger
7028 Address Space Address Space Address Space
7029 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
7030 | | | | | |
7031 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
7032 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
7033 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
7034 | and heap | | | | | |
7035 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
7036 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
7037 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
7038 | | | | | |
7039 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
7040 address | | | | | |
7041 | overlay | <-' | | |
7042 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
7043 | | <---. | | load address
7044 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
7045 | | | |
7046 +-----------+ | |
7047 +-----------+
7048 | |
7049 +-----------+
7050
7051 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
7052 @end group
7053 @end smallexample
7054
7055 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
7056 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
7057 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
7058 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
7059 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
7060 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
7061 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
7062 program and the overlay area.
7063
7064 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
7065 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
7066 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
7067 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
7068 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
7069 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
7070 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
7071
7072 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
7073 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
7074 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
7075
7076 @itemize @bullet
7077
7078 @item
7079 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
7080 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
7081 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
7082 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
7083
7084 @item
7085 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
7086 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
7087 your program's performance.
7088
7089 @item
7090 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
7091 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
7092 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
7093 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
7094 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
7095 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
7096 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
7097
7098 @item
7099 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
7100 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
7101 instruction and data spaces.
7102
7103 @end itemize
7104
7105 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
7106 improved in many ways:
7107
7108 @itemize @bullet
7109
7110 @item
7111 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
7112 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
7113 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
7114 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
7115 area in the usual way.
7116
7117 @item
7118 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
7119 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
7120
7121 @item
7122 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
7123 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
7124 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
7125 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
7126 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
7127 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
7128 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
7129
7130 @end itemize
7131
7132
7133 @node Overlay Commands
7134 @section Overlay Commands
7135
7136 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
7137 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
7138 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
7139 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
7140 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
7141 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
7142
7143 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
7144 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
7145
7146 @table @code
7147 @item overlay off
7148 @kindex overlay off
7149 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
7150 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
7151 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
7152 overlay support is disabled.
7153
7154 @item overlay manual
7155 @kindex overlay manual
7156 @cindex manual overlay debugging
7157 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7158 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
7159 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
7160 commands described below.
7161
7162 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
7163 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
7164 @kindex overlay map-overlay
7165 @cindex map an overlay
7166 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
7167 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
7168 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
7169 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
7170 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
7171 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
7172
7173 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
7174 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
7175 @kindex overlay unmap-overlay
7176 @cindex unmap an overlay
7177 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
7178 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
7179 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
7180 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
7181
7182 @item overlay auto
7183 @kindex overlay auto
7184 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7185 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
7186 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
7187 Overlay Debugging}.
7188
7189 @item overlay load-target
7190 @itemx overlay load
7191 @kindex overlay load-target
7192 @cindex reloading the overlay table
7193 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
7194 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
7195 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
7196 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
7197 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
7198
7199 @item overlay list-overlays
7200 @itemx overlay list
7201 @cindex listing mapped overlays
7202 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
7203 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
7204
7205 @end table
7206
7207 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
7208 of the function the address falls in:
7209
7210 @smallexample
7211 (gdb) print main
7212 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
7213 @end smallexample
7214 @noindent
7215 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
7216 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
7217 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
7218 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
7219
7220 @smallexample
7221 (gdb) overlay list
7222 No sections are mapped.
7223 (gdb) print foo
7224 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
7225 @end smallexample
7226 @noindent
7227 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
7228 name normally:
7229
7230 @smallexample
7231 (gdb) overlay list
7232 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
7233 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
7234 (gdb) print foo
7235 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
7236 @end smallexample
7237
7238 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
7239 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
7240 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
7241 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
7242 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
7243
7244 @itemize @bullet
7245 @item
7246 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
7247 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
7248 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
7249 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
7250 @item
7251 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
7252 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
7253 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
7254 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
7255 breakpoints properly.
7256 @end itemize
7257
7258
7259 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
7260 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
7261 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
7262
7263 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
7264 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
7265 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
7266 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
7267 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
7268 current state of the overlays.
7269
7270 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
7271 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
7272
7273 @table @asis
7274
7275 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
7276 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
7277
7278 @smallexample
7279 struct
7280 @{
7281 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
7282 unsigned long vma;
7283
7284 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
7285 unsigned long size;
7286
7287 /* The overlay's load address. */
7288 unsigned long lma;
7289
7290 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
7291 zero otherwise. */
7292 unsigned long mapped;
7293 @}
7294 @end smallexample
7295
7296 @item @code{_novlys}:
7297 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
7298 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
7299
7300 @end table
7301
7302 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
7303 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
7304 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
7305 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
7306 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
7307 currently mapped.
7308
7309 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
7310 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
7311 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
7312 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
7313 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
7314 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
7315 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
7316 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
7317 are not being executed.
7318
7319 @node Overlay Sample Program
7320 @section Overlay Sample Program
7321 @cindex overlay example program
7322
7323 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
7324 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
7325 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
7326 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
7327 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
7328 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
7329 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
7330
7331 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
7332 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
7333 suite. The program consists of the following files from
7334 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
7335
7336 @table @file
7337 @item overlays.c
7338 The main program file.
7339 @item ovlymgr.c
7340 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
7341 @item foo.c
7342 @itemx bar.c
7343 @itemx baz.c
7344 @itemx grbx.c
7345 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
7346 @item d10v.ld
7347 @itemx m32r.ld
7348 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
7349 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
7350 @end table
7351
7352 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
7353 cross-compiler like this:
7354
7355 @smallexample
7356 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
7357 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
7358 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
7359 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
7360 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
7361 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
7362 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
7363 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
7364 @end smallexample
7365
7366 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
7367 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
7368 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
7369
7370
7371 @node Languages
7372 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
7373 @cindex languages
7374
7375 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
7376 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
7377 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
7378 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
7379 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
7380 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
7381
7382 @cindex working language
7383 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
7384 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
7385 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
7386 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
7387 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
7388 language}.
7389
7390 @menu
7391 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
7392 * Show:: Displaying the language
7393 * Checks:: Type and range checks
7394 * Support:: Supported languages
7395 @end menu
7396
7397 @node Setting
7398 @section Switching between source languages
7399
7400 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
7401 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
7402 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
7403 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
7404 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
7405 are printed, etc.
7406
7407 In addition to the working language, every source file that
7408 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
7409 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
7410 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
7411 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
7412 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
7413 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
7414 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
7415 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
7416 Displaying the language}.
7417
7418 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
7419 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
7420 another language. In that case, make the
7421 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
7422 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
7423 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
7424
7425 @menu
7426 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
7427 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
7428 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7429 @end menu
7430
7431 @node Filenames
7432 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
7433
7434 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
7435 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
7436
7437 @table @file
7438
7439 @item .c
7440 C source file
7441
7442 @item .C
7443 @itemx .cc
7444 @itemx .cp
7445 @itemx .cpp
7446 @itemx .cxx
7447 @itemx .c++
7448 C@t{++} source file
7449
7450 @item .f
7451 @itemx .F
7452 Fortran source file
7453
7454 @c OBSOLETE @item .ch
7455 @c OBSOLETE @itemx .c186
7456 @c OBSOLETE @itemx .c286
7457 @c OBSOLETE CHILL source file
7458
7459 @item .mod
7460 Modula-2 source file
7461
7462 @item .s
7463 @itemx .S
7464 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
7465 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
7466 @end table
7467
7468 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
7469 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
7470
7471 @node Manually
7472 @subsection Setting the working language
7473
7474 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
7475 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
7476 your program.
7477
7478 @kindex set language
7479 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
7480 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
7481 a language, such as
7482 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
7483 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
7484
7485 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
7486 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
7487 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
7488 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
7489 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
7490 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
7491 command such as:
7492
7493 @smallexample
7494 print a = b + c
7495 @end smallexample
7496
7497 @noindent
7498 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
7499 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
7500 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
7501 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
7502
7503 @node Automatically
7504 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7505
7506 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
7507 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
7508 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
7509 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
7510 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
7511 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
7512 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
7513 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
7514 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
7515
7516 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
7517 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
7518 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
7519 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
7520 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
7521
7522 @node Show
7523 @section Displaying the language
7524
7525 The following commands help you find out which language is the
7526 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
7527
7528 @kindex show language
7529 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
7530 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
7531 @table @code
7532 @item show language
7533 Display the current working language. This is the
7534 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
7535 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
7536
7537 @item info frame
7538 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
7539 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
7540 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
7541 information listed here.
7542
7543 @item info source
7544 Display the source language of this source file.
7545 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
7546 information listed here.
7547 @end table
7548
7549 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
7550 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
7551 with a language explicitly:
7552
7553 @kindex set extension-language
7554 @kindex info extensions
7555 @table @code
7556 @item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
7557 Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
7558 the source language @var{language}.
7559
7560 @item info extensions
7561 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
7562 @end table
7563
7564 @node Checks
7565 @section Type and range checking
7566
7567 @quotation
7568 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
7569 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
7570 section documents the intended facilities.
7571 @end quotation
7572 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
7573
7574 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
7575 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
7576 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
7577 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
7578 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
7579 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
7580 errors when your program is running.
7581
7582 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
7583 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
7584 can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
7585 the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
7586 @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
7587 your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
7588 for the default settings of supported languages.
7589
7590 @menu
7591 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
7592 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
7593 @end menu
7594
7595 @cindex type checking
7596 @cindex checks, type
7597 @node Type Checking
7598 @subsection An overview of type checking
7599
7600 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7601 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7602 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7603 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7604
7605 @smallexample
7606 1 + 2 @result{} 3
7607 @exdent but
7608 @error{} 1 + 2.3
7609 @end smallexample
7610
7611 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7612 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7613
7614 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7615 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7616 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7617 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
7618 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7619 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7620 also issues a warning.
7621
7622 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7623 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7624 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7625 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7626 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
7627 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7628
7629 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7630 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7631 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7632 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7633 operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7634 details on specific languages.
7635
7636 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7637
7638 @kindex set check@r{, type}
7639 @kindex set check type
7640 @kindex show check type
7641 @table @code
7642 @item set check type auto
7643 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7644 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7645 each language.
7646
7647 @item set check type on
7648 @itemx set check type off
7649 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7650 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7651 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
7652 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
7653 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7654
7655 @item set check type warn
7656 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7657 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7658 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7659 numbers and structures.
7660
7661 @item show type
7662 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
7663 is setting it automatically.
7664 @end table
7665
7666 @cindex range checking
7667 @cindex checks, range
7668 @node Range Checking
7669 @subsection An overview of range checking
7670
7671 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7672 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7673 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7674 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7675 not exceed the bounds of the array.
7676
7677 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7678 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7679 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7680 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7681
7682 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7683 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7684 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7685 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7686 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7687 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7688
7689 @smallexample
7690 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
7691 @end smallexample
7692
7693 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7694 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7695 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7696
7697 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7698
7699 @kindex set check@r{, range}
7700 @kindex set check range
7701 @kindex show check range
7702 @table @code
7703 @item set check range auto
7704 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7705 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7706 each language.
7707
7708 @item set check range on
7709 @itemx set check range off
7710 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7711 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
7712 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7713 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
7714
7715 @item set check range warn
7716 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7717 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7718 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7719 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7720 systems).
7721
7722 @item show range
7723 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7724 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7725 @end table
7726
7727 @node Support
7728 @section Supported languages
7729
7730 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java,
7731 @c OBSOLETE Chill,
7732 assembly, and Modula-2.
7733 @c This is false ...
7734 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7735 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7736 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7737 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7738 language.
7739
7740 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7741 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7742 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7743 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7744 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7745 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7746 language reference or tutorial.
7747
7748 @menu
7749 * C:: C and C@t{++}
7750 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
7751 @c OBSOLETE * Chill:: Chill
7752 @end menu
7753
7754 @node C
7755 @subsection C and C@t{++}
7756
7757 @cindex C and C@t{++}
7758 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
7759
7760 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
7761 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7762 together.
7763
7764 @cindex C@t{++}
7765 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
7766 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7767 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7768 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7769 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7770 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
7771 compiler (@code{aCC}).
7772
7773 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
7774 format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
7775 command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
7776 @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7777 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
7778
7779 @menu
7780 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7781 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7782 * C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7783 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7784 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7785 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
7786 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
7787 @end menu
7788
7789 @node C Operators
7790 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7791
7792 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
7793
7794 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7795 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7796 often defined on groups of types.
7797
7798 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
7799
7800 @itemize @bullet
7801
7802 @item
7803 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
7804 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
7805
7806 @item
7807 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7808 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
7809
7810 @item
7811 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
7812
7813 @item
7814 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
7815
7816 @end itemize
7817
7818 @noindent
7819 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7820 in order of increasing precedence:
7821
7822 @table @code
7823 @item ,
7824 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7825 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7826 expression being the last expression evaluated.
7827
7828 @item =
7829 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7830 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7831
7832 @item @var{op}=
7833 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7834 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
7835 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
7836 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7837 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7838
7839 @item ?:
7840 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7841 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7842 integral type.
7843
7844 @item ||
7845 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7846
7847 @item &&
7848 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7849
7850 @item |
7851 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7852
7853 @item ^
7854 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7855
7856 @item &
7857 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7858
7859 @item ==@r{, }!=
7860 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7861 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
7862
7863 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
7864 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
7865 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
7866 and non-zero for true.
7867
7868 @item <<@r{, }>>
7869 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
7870
7871 @item @@
7872 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7873
7874 @item +@r{, }-
7875 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
7876 pointer types.
7877
7878 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
7879 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
7880 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
7881 integral types.
7882
7883 @item ++@r{, }--
7884 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
7885 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
7886 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
7887 operation takes place.
7888
7889 @item *
7890 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
7891 @code{++}.
7892
7893 @item &
7894 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
7895
7896 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
7897 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
7898 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
7899 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
7900 stored.
7901
7902 @item -
7903 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
7904 precedence as @code{++}.
7905
7906 @item !
7907 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7908 @code{++}.
7909
7910 @item ~
7911 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7912 @code{++}.
7913
7914
7915 @item .@r{, }->
7916 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
7917 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
7918 pointer based on the stored type information.
7919 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
7920
7921 @item .*@r{, }->*
7922 Dereferences of pointers to members.
7923
7924 @item []
7925 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
7926 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7927
7928 @item ()
7929 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7930
7931 @item ::
7932 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7933 and @code{class} types.
7934
7935 @item ::
7936 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
7937 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
7938 above.
7939 @end table
7940
7941 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
7942 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
7943 predefined meaning.
7944
7945 @menu
7946 * C Constants::
7947 @end menu
7948
7949 @node C Constants
7950 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
7951
7952 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
7953
7954 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
7955 following ways:
7956
7957 @itemize @bullet
7958 @item
7959 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
7960 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
7961 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
7962 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
7963 @code{long} value.
7964
7965 @item
7966 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
7967 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
7968 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
7969 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
7970 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
7971 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
7972 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
7973 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
7974 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
7975 constant.
7976
7977 @item
7978 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
7979 integral equivalents.
7980
7981 @item
7982 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
7983 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
7984 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
7985 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
7986 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
7987 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
7988 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
7989 @samp{\n} for newline.
7990
7991 @item
7992 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
7993 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
7994 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
7995 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
7996 characters.
7997
7998 @item
7999 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
8000 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
8001
8002 @item
8003 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
8004 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
8005 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
8006 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
8007 @end itemize
8008
8009 @menu
8010 * C plus plus expressions::
8011 * C Defaults::
8012 * C Checks::
8013
8014 * Debugging C::
8015 @end menu
8016
8017 @node C plus plus expressions
8018 @subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
8019
8020 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
8021 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
8022
8023 @cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
8024 @cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
8025 @cindex C@t{++} and object formats
8026 @cindex object formats and C@t{++}
8027 @cindex a.out and C@t{++}
8028 @cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
8029 @cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
8030 @cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
8031 @cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
8032 @c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
8033 @c periodically whether this has happened...
8034 @quotation
8035 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
8036 proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
8037 additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
8038 special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
8039 @sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
8040 symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
8041 you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
8042 extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
8043 @sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
8044 support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
8045 @end quotation
8046
8047 @enumerate
8048
8049 @cindex member functions
8050 @item
8051 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
8052
8053 @smallexample
8054 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
8055 @end smallexample
8056
8057 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
8058 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
8059 @item
8060 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
8061 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
8062 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
8063 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
8064
8065 @cindex call overloaded functions
8066 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
8067 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
8068 @item
8069 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
8070 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
8071 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
8072 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
8073 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
8074 default arguments.
8075
8076 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
8077 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
8078 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
8079 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
8080 number of function arguments.
8081
8082 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
8083 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
8084 ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
8085
8086 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
8087 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
8088 @smallexample
8089 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
8090 @end smallexample
8091
8092 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
8093 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
8094
8095 @cindex reference declarations
8096 @item
8097 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
8098 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
8099 dereferenced.
8100
8101 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
8102 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
8103 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
8104 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
8105 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
8106
8107 @item
8108 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
8109 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
8110 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
8111 necessary, for example in an expression like
8112 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
8113 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
8114 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
8115 @end enumerate
8116
8117 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
8118 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
8119 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
8120 invoking user-defined operators.
8121
8122 @node C Defaults
8123 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
8124
8125 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
8126
8127 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
8128 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
8129 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8130 selects the working language.
8131
8132 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
8133 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
8134 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
8135 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
8136 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
8137 for further details.
8138
8139 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
8140 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
8141 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
8142
8143 @node C Checks
8144 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
8145
8146 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
8147
8148 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
8149 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
8150 considers two variables type equivalent if:
8151
8152 @itemize @bullet
8153 @item
8154 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
8155 enumerated tag.
8156
8157 @item
8158 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
8159 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
8160
8161 @ignore
8162 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
8163 @c FIXME--beers?
8164 @item
8165 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
8166 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
8167 compilers.)
8168 @end ignore
8169 @end itemize
8170
8171 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
8172 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
8173 that is not itself an array.
8174
8175 @node Debugging C
8176 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
8177
8178 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
8179 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
8180 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
8181 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
8182
8183 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
8184 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
8185 ,Expressions}.
8186
8187 @menu
8188 * Debugging C plus plus::
8189 @end menu
8190
8191 @node Debugging C plus plus
8192 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
8193
8194 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
8195
8196 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
8197 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
8198
8199 @table @code
8200 @cindex break in overloaded functions
8201 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
8202 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
8203 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
8204 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
8205
8206 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
8207 @item rbreak @var{regex}
8208 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
8209 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
8210 classes.
8211 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
8212
8213 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
8214 @item catch throw
8215 @itemx catch catch
8216 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
8217 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
8218
8219 @cindex inheritance
8220 @item ptype @var{typename}
8221 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
8222 @var{typename}.
8223 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
8224
8225 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
8226 @item set print demangle
8227 @itemx show print demangle
8228 @itemx set print asm-demangle
8229 @itemx show print asm-demangle
8230 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
8231 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
8232 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8233
8234 @item set print object
8235 @itemx show print object
8236 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
8237 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8238
8239 @item set print vtbl
8240 @itemx show print vtbl
8241 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
8242 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8243 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
8244 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
8245
8246 @kindex set overload-resolution
8247 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
8248 @item set overload-resolution on
8249 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
8250 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
8251 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
8252 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
8253 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
8254 message.
8255
8256 @item set overload-resolution off
8257 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
8258 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8259 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
8260 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
8261 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8262 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
8263 argument types.
8264
8265 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
8266 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
8267 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
8268 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
8269 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
8270 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
8271 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
8272 @end table
8273
8274 @node Modula-2
8275 @subsection Modula-2
8276
8277 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
8278
8279 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
8280 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
8281 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
8282 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
8283 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8284 table.
8285
8286 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
8287 @menu
8288 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
8289 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
8290 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
8291 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
8292 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
8293 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
8294 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8295 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8296 @end menu
8297
8298 @node M2 Operators
8299 @subsubsection Operators
8300 @cindex Modula-2 operators
8301
8302 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8303 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8304 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
8305 following definitions hold:
8306
8307 @itemize @bullet
8308
8309 @item
8310 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
8311 their subranges.
8312
8313 @item
8314 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
8315
8316 @item
8317 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
8318
8319 @item
8320 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
8321 @var{type}}.
8322
8323 @item
8324 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
8325
8326 @item
8327 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
8328
8329 @item
8330 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
8331 @end itemize
8332
8333 @noindent
8334 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
8335 increasing precedence:
8336
8337 @table @code
8338 @item ,
8339 Function argument or array index separator.
8340
8341 @item :=
8342 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
8343 @var{value}.
8344
8345 @item <@r{, }>
8346 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
8347 types.
8348
8349 @item <=@r{, }>=
8350 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
8351 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
8352 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
8353
8354 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
8355 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
8356 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
8357 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
8358 comment character.
8359
8360 @item IN
8361 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
8362 Same precedence as @code{<}.
8363
8364 @item OR
8365 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8366
8367 @item AND@r{, }&
8368 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8369
8370 @item @@
8371 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8372
8373 @item +@r{, }-
8374 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
8375 and difference on set types.
8376
8377 @item *
8378 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
8379 on set types.
8380
8381 @item /
8382 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
8383 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
8384
8385 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
8386 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
8387 precedence as @code{*}.
8388
8389 @item -
8390 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
8391
8392 @item ^
8393 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
8394
8395 @item NOT
8396 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
8397 @code{^}.
8398
8399 @item .
8400 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
8401 precedence as @code{^}.
8402
8403 @item []
8404 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
8405
8406 @item ()
8407 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
8408 as @code{^}.
8409
8410 @item ::@r{, }.
8411 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
8412 @end table
8413
8414 @quotation
8415 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
8416 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
8417 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
8418 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
8419 @end quotation
8420
8421
8422 @node Built-In Func/Proc
8423 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
8424 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
8425
8426 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
8427 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
8428
8429 @table @var
8430
8431 @item a
8432 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
8433
8434 @item c
8435 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
8436
8437 @item i
8438 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
8439
8440 @item m
8441 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
8442 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
8443 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
8444
8445 @item n
8446 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
8447
8448 @item r
8449 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
8450
8451 @item t
8452 represents a type.
8453
8454 @item v
8455 represents a variable.
8456
8457 @item x
8458 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
8459 explanation of the function for details.
8460 @end table
8461
8462 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
8463
8464 @table @code
8465 @item ABS(@var{n})
8466 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
8467
8468 @item CAP(@var{c})
8469 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
8470 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
8471
8472 @item CHR(@var{i})
8473 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8474
8475 @item DEC(@var{v})
8476 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
8477
8478 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
8479 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8480 new value.
8481
8482 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8483 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
8484 set.
8485
8486 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
8487 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
8488
8489 @item HIGH(@var{a})
8490 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
8491
8492 @item INC(@var{v})
8493 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
8494
8495 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
8496 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8497 new value.
8498
8499 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8500 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
8501 there. Returns the new set.
8502
8503 @item MAX(@var{t})
8504 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
8505
8506 @item MIN(@var{t})
8507 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
8508
8509 @item ODD(@var{i})
8510 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
8511
8512 @item ORD(@var{x})
8513 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
8514 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
8515 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
8516 integral, character and enumerated types.
8517
8518 @item SIZE(@var{x})
8519 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
8520
8521 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
8522 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
8523
8524 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
8525 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8526 @end table
8527
8528 @quotation
8529 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
8530 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
8531 an error.
8532 @end quotation
8533
8534 @cindex Modula-2 constants
8535 @node M2 Constants
8536 @subsubsection Constants
8537
8538 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
8539 ways:
8540
8541 @itemize @bullet
8542
8543 @item
8544 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
8545 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
8546 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
8547 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
8548
8549 @item
8550 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
8551 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
8552 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
8553 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
8554 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
8555 digits.
8556
8557 @item
8558 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
8559 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
8560 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
8561 followed by a @samp{C}.
8562
8563 @item
8564 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
8565 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
8566 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
8567 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
8568 sequences.
8569
8570 @item
8571 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
8572
8573 @item
8574 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
8575 @code{FALSE}.
8576
8577 @item
8578 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
8579
8580 @item
8581 Set constants are not yet supported.
8582 @end itemize
8583
8584 @node M2 Defaults
8585 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
8586 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
8587
8588 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8589 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
8590 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8591 selected the working language.
8592
8593 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8594 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
8595 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
8596 the language automatically}, for further details.
8597
8598 @node Deviations
8599 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8600 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8601
8602 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8603 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8604
8605 @itemize @bullet
8606 @item
8607 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
8608 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
8609 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
8610 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
8611 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
8612 returned a pointer.)
8613
8614 @item
8615 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
8616 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
8617 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
8618 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
8619
8620 @item
8621 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
8622 argument.
8623
8624 @item
8625 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
8626 @end itemize
8627
8628 @node M2 Checks
8629 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
8630 @cindex Modula-2 checks
8631
8632 @quotation
8633 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
8634 range checking.
8635 @end quotation
8636 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
8637
8638 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
8639
8640 @itemize @bullet
8641 @item
8642 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
8643 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
8644
8645 @item
8646 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
8647 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
8648 @end itemize
8649
8650 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
8651 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
8652
8653 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8654 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
8655
8656 @node M2 Scope
8657 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8658 @cindex scope
8659 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
8660 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8661 @ifinfo
8662 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
8663 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8664 @end ifinfo
8665 @iftex
8666 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
8667 @end iftex
8668
8669 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8670 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8671 similar syntax:
8672
8673 @smallexample
8674
8675 @var{module} . @var{id}
8676 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
8677 @end smallexample
8678
8679 @noindent
8680 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8681 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8682 identifier within your program, except another module.
8683
8684 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8685 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8686 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8687 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8688
8689 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8690 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8691 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8692 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8693 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8694 @var{module}.
8695
8696 @node GDB/M2
8697 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8698
8699 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8700 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
8701 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
8702 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
8703 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
8704 analogue in Modula-2.
8705
8706 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
8707 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
8708 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
8709 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
8710 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
8711 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
8712
8713 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8714 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8715 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
8716
8717 @c OBSOLETE @node Chill
8718 @c OBSOLETE @subsection Chill
8719 @c OBSOLETE
8720 @c OBSOLETE The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
8721 @c OBSOLETE from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
8722 @c OBSOLETE supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
8723 @c OBSOLETE likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8724 @c OBSOLETE table.
8725 @c OBSOLETE
8726 @c OBSOLETE @c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
8727 @c OBSOLETE @c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
8728 @c OBSOLETE This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
8729 @c OBSOLETE of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
8730 @c OBSOLETE
8731 @c OBSOLETE @menu
8732 @c OBSOLETE * How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
8733 @c OBSOLETE * Locations:: Locations and their accesses
8734 @c OBSOLETE * Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
8735 @c OBSOLETE * Chill type and range checks::
8736 @c OBSOLETE * Chill defaults::
8737 @c OBSOLETE @end menu
8738 @c OBSOLETE
8739 @c OBSOLETE @node How modes are displayed
8740 @c OBSOLETE @subsubsection How modes are displayed
8741 @c OBSOLETE
8742 @c OBSOLETE The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
8743 @c OBSOLETE with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
8744 @c OBSOLETE slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
8745 @c OBSOLETE provided modes are:
8746 @c OBSOLETE
8747 @c OBSOLETE @c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
8748 @c OBSOLETE @c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
8749 @c OBSOLETE @table @code
8750 @c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
8751 @c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8752 @c OBSOLETE @item
8753 @c OBSOLETE @emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
8754 @c OBSOLETE UINT, LONG, ULONG},
8755 @c OBSOLETE @item
8756 @c OBSOLETE @emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
8757 @c OBSOLETE @item
8758 @c OBSOLETE @emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
8759 @c OBSOLETE @item
8760 @c OBSOLETE @emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
8761 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8762 @c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8763 @c OBSOLETE type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
8764 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8765 @c OBSOLETE If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
8766 @c OBSOLETE @item
8767 @c OBSOLETE @emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
8768 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8769 @c OBSOLETE @code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
8770 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8771 @c OBSOLETE where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
8772 @c OBSOLETE expression (e.g. set element names).
8773 @c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8774 @c OBSOLETE
8775 @c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
8776 @c OBSOLETE A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
8777 @c OBSOLETE the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
8778 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8779 @c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8780 @c OBSOLETE type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
8781 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8782 @c OBSOLETE
8783 @c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
8784 @c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8785 @c OBSOLETE @item
8786 @c OBSOLETE @emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
8787 @c OBSOLETE followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
8788 @c OBSOLETE @item
8789 @c OBSOLETE @emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
8790 @c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8791 @c OBSOLETE
8792 @c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
8793 @c OBSOLETE The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
8794 @c OBSOLETE <return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
8795 @c OBSOLETE list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
8796 @c OBSOLETE the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
8797 @c OBSOLETE all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
8798 @c OBSOLETE
8799 @c OBSOLETE @ignore
8800 @c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
8801 @c OBSOLETE The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
8802 @c OBSOLETE type, and is therefore not really of interest.
8803 @c OBSOLETE @end ignore
8804 @c OBSOLETE
8805 @c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
8806 @c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8807 @c OBSOLETE @item
8808 @c OBSOLETE @emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
8809 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8810 @c OBSOLETE @code{EVENT (<event length>)}
8811 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8812 @c OBSOLETE where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
8813 @c OBSOLETE @item
8814 @c OBSOLETE @emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
8815 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8816 @c OBSOLETE @code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
8817 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8818 @c OBSOLETE where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
8819 @c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8820 @c OBSOLETE
8821 @c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
8822 @c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8823 @c OBSOLETE @item
8824 @c OBSOLETE @emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
8825 @c OBSOLETE @item
8826 @c OBSOLETE @emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
8827 @c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8828 @c OBSOLETE
8829 @c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
8830 @c OBSOLETE Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
8831 @c OBSOLETE
8832 @c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
8833 @c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8834 @c OBSOLETE @item
8835 @c OBSOLETE @emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
8836 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8837 @c OBSOLETE @code{CHARS(<string length>)}
8838 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8839 @c OBSOLETE followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
8840 @c OBSOLETE mode
8841 @c OBSOLETE @item
8842 @c OBSOLETE @emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
8843 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8844 @c OBSOLETE @code{BOOLS(<string
8845 @c OBSOLETE length>)}
8846 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8847 @c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8848 @c OBSOLETE
8849 @c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
8850 @c OBSOLETE The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
8851 @c OBSOLETE followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
8852 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8853 @c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8854 @c OBSOLETE type = ARRAY (1:42)
8855 @c OBSOLETE ARRAY (1:20)
8856 @c OBSOLETE SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
8857 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8858 @c OBSOLETE
8859 @c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
8860 @c OBSOLETE The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
8861 @c OBSOLETE list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
8862 @c OBSOLETE of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
8863 @c OBSOLETE OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
8864 @c OBSOLETE of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
8865 @c OBSOLETE checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
8866 @c OBSOLETE always displays all variant fields.
8867 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8868 @c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) ptype str
8869 @c OBSOLETE type = STRUCT (
8870 @c OBSOLETE as x,
8871 @c OBSOLETE bs x,
8872 @c OBSOLETE CASE bs OF
8873 @c OBSOLETE (karli):
8874 @c OBSOLETE cs a
8875 @c OBSOLETE (ott):
8876 @c OBSOLETE ds x
8877 @c OBSOLETE ESAC
8878 @c OBSOLETE )
8879 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8880 @c OBSOLETE @end table
8881 @c OBSOLETE
8882 @c OBSOLETE @node Locations
8883 @c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Locations and their accesses
8884 @c OBSOLETE
8885 @c OBSOLETE A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
8886 @c OBSOLETE
8887 @c OBSOLETE A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
8888 @c OBSOLETE the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
8889 @c OBSOLETE Chill programs. How values are specified
8890 @c OBSOLETE is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
8891 @c OBSOLETE
8892 @c OBSOLETE The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
8893 @c OBSOLETE display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
8894 @c OBSOLETE
8895 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8896 @c OBSOLETE set result := EXPR
8897 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8898 @c OBSOLETE
8899 @c OBSOLETE @noindent
8900 @c OBSOLETE This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
8901 @c OBSOLETE is not available in @value{GDBN}).
8902 @c OBSOLETE
8903 @c OBSOLETE Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
8904 @c OBSOLETE value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
8905 @c OBSOLETE mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
8906 @c OBSOLETE represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
8907 @c OBSOLETE value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
8908 @c OBSOLETE operator @samp{->}.
8909 @c OBSOLETE
8910 @c OBSOLETE Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
8911 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8912 @c OBSOLETE @code{@{ PROC
8913 @c OBSOLETE (<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
8914 @c OBSOLETE location>}
8915 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8916 @c OBSOLETE @code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
8917 @c OBSOLETE specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
8918 @c OBSOLETE the entry point.
8919 @c OBSOLETE
8920 @c OBSOLETE @ignore
8921 @c OBSOLETE Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
8922 @c OBSOLETE fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
8923 @c OBSOLETE the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
8924 @c OBSOLETE implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
8925 @c OBSOLETE na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
8926 @c OBSOLETE <instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
8927 @c OBSOLETE @code{__proc_copy}.
8928 @c OBSOLETE
8929 @c OBSOLETE Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
8930 @c OBSOLETE the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
8931 @c OBSOLETE like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
8932 @c OBSOLETE mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
8933 @c OBSOLETE
8934 @c OBSOLETE Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
8935 @c OBSOLETE ...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
8936 @c OBSOLETE definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
8937 @c OBSOLETE of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
8938 @c OBSOLETE structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
8939 @c OBSOLETE braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
8940 @c OBSOLETE on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
8941 @c OBSOLETE memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
8942 @c OBSOLETE all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
8943 @c OBSOLETE @code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
8944 @c OBSOLETE stuff ???)
8945 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8946 @c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
8947 @c OBSOLETE [.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
8948 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8949 @c OBSOLETE @end ignore
8950 @c OBSOLETE
8951 @c OBSOLETE Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
8952 @c OBSOLETE (e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
8953 @c OBSOLETE certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
8954 @c OBSOLETE and their Operations}.
8955 @c OBSOLETE
8956 @c OBSOLETE A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
8957 @c OBSOLETE location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
8958 @c OBSOLETE name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
8959 @c OBSOLETE have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
8960 @c OBSOLETE checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
8961 @c OBSOLETE therefore the result can be quite confusing.
8962 @c OBSOLETE
8963 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8964 @c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
8965 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8966 @c OBSOLETE
8967 @c OBSOLETE @node Values and their Operations
8968 @c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Values and their Operations
8969 @c OBSOLETE
8970 @c OBSOLETE Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
8971 @c OBSOLETE more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
8972 @c OBSOLETE data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
8973 @c OBSOLETE such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
8974 @c OBSOLETE constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
8975 @c OBSOLETE when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
8976 @c OBSOLETE (e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
8977 @c OBSOLETE the values behind these locations.
8978 @c OBSOLETE
8979 @c OBSOLETE This section describes how values have to be specified and which
8980 @c OBSOLETE operations are legal to be used with such values.
8981 @c OBSOLETE
8982 @c OBSOLETE @table @code
8983 @c OBSOLETE @item Literal Values
8984 @c OBSOLETE Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
8985 @c OBSOLETE For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
8986 @c OBSOLETE chapter 1.5.
8987 @c OBSOLETE @c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
8988 @c OBSOLETE @c be converted to a @ref.
8989 @c OBSOLETE
8990 @c OBSOLETE @ignore
8991 @c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8992 @c OBSOLETE @item
8993 @c OBSOLETE @emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
8994 @c OBSOLETE programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
8995 @c OBSOLETE @item
8996 @c OBSOLETE @emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
8997 @c OBSOLETE @item
8998 @c OBSOLETE @emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
8999 @c OBSOLETE @code{'M'})
9000 @c OBSOLETE @item
9001 @c OBSOLETE @emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
9002 @c OBSOLETE mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
9003 @c OBSOLETE comparable to an enumeration in C/C@t{++} language.
9004 @c OBSOLETE @item
9005 @c OBSOLETE @emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
9006 @c OBSOLETE emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
9007 @c OBSOLETE procedure value or the empty instance value.
9008 @c OBSOLETE
9009 @c OBSOLETE @item
9010 @c OBSOLETE @emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
9011 @c OBSOLETE enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
9012 @c OBSOLETE to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
9013 @c OBSOLETE @item
9014 @c OBSOLETE @emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
9015 @c OBSOLETE programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
9016 @c OBSOLETE @item
9017 @c OBSOLETE @emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
9018 @c OBSOLETE (gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
9019 @c OBSOLETE @end itemize
9020 @c OBSOLETE @end ignore
9021 @c OBSOLETE
9022 @c OBSOLETE @item Tuple Values
9023 @c OBSOLETE A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
9024 @c OBSOLETE name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
9025 @c OBSOLETE unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
9026 @c OBSOLETE @code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
9027 @c OBSOLETE
9028 @c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
9029 @c OBSOLETE @item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
9030 @c OBSOLETE @item @emph{Array Tuple}
9031 @c OBSOLETE @item @emph{Structure Tuple}
9032 @c OBSOLETE Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
9033 @c OBSOLETE same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
9034 @c OBSOLETE @end itemize
9035 @c OBSOLETE
9036 @c OBSOLETE @item String Element Value
9037 @c OBSOLETE A string element value is specified by
9038 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
9039 @c OBSOLETE @code{<string value>(<index>)}
9040 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
9041 @c OBSOLETE where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
9042 @c OBSOLETE value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
9043 @c OBSOLETE the string.
9044 @c OBSOLETE
9045 @c OBSOLETE @item String Slice Value
9046 @c OBSOLETE A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
9047 @c OBSOLETE spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
9048 @c OBSOLETE expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
9049 @c OBSOLETE @code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
9050 @c OBSOLETE The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
9051 @c OBSOLETE string.
9052 @c OBSOLETE
9053 @c OBSOLETE @item Array Element Values
9054 @c OBSOLETE An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
9055 @c OBSOLETE delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
9056 @c OBSOLETE
9057 @c OBSOLETE @item Array Slice Values
9058 @c OBSOLETE An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
9059 @c OBSOLETE @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
9060 @c OBSOLETE @code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
9061 @c OBSOLETE arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
9062 @c OBSOLETE which is part of the specified array.
9063 @c OBSOLETE
9064 @c OBSOLETE @item Structure Field Values
9065 @c OBSOLETE A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
9066 @c OBSOLETE name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
9067 @c OBSOLETE in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
9068 @c OBSOLETE corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
9069 @c OBSOLETE
9070 @c OBSOLETE @item Procedure Call Value
9071 @c OBSOLETE The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
9072 @c OBSOLETE procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
9073 @c OBSOLETE expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
9074 @c OBSOLETE effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
9075 @c OBSOLETE
9076 @c OBSOLETE Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
9077 @c OBSOLETE
9078 @c OBSOLETE Values of time mode locations appear as
9079 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
9080 @c OBSOLETE @code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
9081 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
9082 @c OBSOLETE
9083 @c OBSOLETE
9084 @c OBSOLETE @ignore
9085 @c OBSOLETE This is not implemented yet:
9086 @c OBSOLETE @item Built-in Value
9087 @c OBSOLETE @noindent
9088 @c OBSOLETE The following built in functions are provided:
9089 @c OBSOLETE
9090 @c OBSOLETE @table @code
9091 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{ADDR()}
9092 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{NUM()}
9093 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{PRED()}
9094 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{SUCC()}
9095 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{ABS()}
9096 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{CARD()}
9097 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{MAX()}
9098 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{MIN()}
9099 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{SIZE()}
9100 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{UPPER()}
9101 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{LOWER()}
9102 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{LENGTH()}
9103 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{SIN()}
9104 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{COS()}
9105 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{TAN()}
9106 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{ARCSIN()}
9107 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{ARCCOS()}
9108 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{ARCTAN()}
9109 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{EXP()}
9110 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{LN()}
9111 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{LOG()}
9112 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{SQRT()}
9113 @c OBSOLETE @end table
9114 @c OBSOLETE
9115 @c OBSOLETE For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
9116 @c OBSOLETE chapter 1.6.
9117 @c OBSOLETE @end ignore
9118 @c OBSOLETE
9119 @c OBSOLETE @item Zero-adic Operator Value
9120 @c OBSOLETE The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
9121 @c OBSOLETE current active process.
9122 @c OBSOLETE
9123 @c OBSOLETE @item Expression Values
9124 @c OBSOLETE The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
9125 @c OBSOLETE the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
9126 @c OBSOLETE incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
9127 @c OBSOLETE corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
9128 @c OBSOLETE causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
9129 @c OBSOLETE which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
9130 @c OBSOLETE operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
9131 @c OBSOLETE
9132 @c OBSOLETE @table @code
9133 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
9134 @c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
9135 @c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{NOT}
9136 @c OBSOLETE Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
9137 @c OBSOLETE
9138 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{=, /=}
9139 @c OBSOLETE Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
9140 @c OBSOLETE
9141 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{>, >=}
9142 @c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{<, <=}
9143 @c OBSOLETE Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
9144 @c OBSOLETE
9145 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{+, -}
9146 @c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
9147 @c OBSOLETE Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
9148 @c OBSOLETE
9149 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{-}
9150 @c OBSOLETE Change sign operator.
9151 @c OBSOLETE
9152 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{//}
9153 @c OBSOLETE String concatenation operator.
9154 @c OBSOLETE
9155 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{()}
9156 @c OBSOLETE String repetition operator.
9157 @c OBSOLETE
9158 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{->}
9159 @c OBSOLETE Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
9160 @c OBSOLETE address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
9161 @c OBSOLETE location (@code{loc->}).
9162 @c OBSOLETE
9163 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{OR, XOR}
9164 @c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{AND}
9165 @c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{NOT}
9166 @c OBSOLETE Powerset and bitstring operators.
9167 @c OBSOLETE
9168 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{>, >=}
9169 @c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{<, <=}
9170 @c OBSOLETE Powerset inclusion operators.
9171 @c OBSOLETE
9172 @c OBSOLETE @item @code{IN}
9173 @c OBSOLETE Membership operator.
9174 @c OBSOLETE @end table
9175 @c OBSOLETE @end table
9176 @c OBSOLETE
9177 @c OBSOLETE @node Chill type and range checks
9178 @c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Chill type and range checks
9179 @c OBSOLETE
9180 @c OBSOLETE @value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
9181 @c OBSOLETE of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
9182 @c OBSOLETE complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
9183 @c OBSOLETE equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
9184 @c OBSOLETE structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
9185 @c OBSOLETE
9186 @c OBSOLETE Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
9187 @c OBSOLETE index bounds and all built in procedures.
9188 @c OBSOLETE
9189 @c OBSOLETE Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
9190 @c OBSOLETE check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
9191 @c OBSOLETE operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
9192 @c OBSOLETE functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
9193 @c OBSOLETE language specification.
9194 @c OBSOLETE
9195 @c OBSOLETE All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
9196 @c OBSOLETE off}.
9197 @c OBSOLETE
9198 @c OBSOLETE @ignore
9199 @c OBSOLETE @c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
9200 @c OBSOLETE see last paragraph ?
9201 @c OBSOLETE @end ignore
9202 @c OBSOLETE
9203 @c OBSOLETE @node Chill defaults
9204 @c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Chill defaults
9205 @c OBSOLETE
9206 @c OBSOLETE If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
9207 @c OBSOLETE both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
9208 @c OBSOLETE Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9209 @c OBSOLETE selected the working language.
9210 @c OBSOLETE
9211 @c OBSOLETE If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
9212 @c OBSOLETE code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
9213 @c OBSOLETE working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
9214 @c OBSOLETE the language automatically}, for further details.
9215
9216 @node Symbols
9217 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
9218
9219 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
9220 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
9221 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
9222 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
9223 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
9224 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
9225 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9226
9227 @cindex symbol names
9228 @cindex names of symbols
9229 @cindex quoting names
9230 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
9231 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
9232 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
9233 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
9234 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
9235 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
9236 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
9237 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
9238
9239 @smallexample
9240 p 'foo.c'::x
9241 @end smallexample
9242
9243 @noindent
9244 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
9245
9246 @table @code
9247 @kindex info address
9248 @cindex address of a symbol
9249 @item info address @var{symbol}
9250 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
9251 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
9252 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
9253 is always stored.
9254
9255 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
9256 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
9257 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
9258
9259 @kindex info symbol
9260 @cindex symbol from address
9261 @item info symbol @var{addr}
9262 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
9263 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
9264 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
9265
9266 @smallexample
9267 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
9268 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
9269 @end smallexample
9270
9271 @noindent
9272 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
9273 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
9274
9275 @kindex whatis
9276 @item whatis @var{expr}
9277 Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
9278 actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
9279 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
9280 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9281
9282 @item whatis
9283 Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
9284
9285 @kindex ptype
9286 @item ptype @var{typename}
9287 Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
9288 the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
9289 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
9290 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
9291
9292 @item ptype @var{expr}
9293 @itemx ptype
9294 Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
9295 differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
9296 of just the name of the type.
9297
9298 For example, for this variable declaration:
9299
9300 @smallexample
9301 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
9302 @end smallexample
9303
9304 @noindent
9305 the two commands give this output:
9306
9307 @smallexample
9308 @group
9309 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
9310 type = struct complex
9311 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
9312 type = struct complex @{
9313 double real;
9314 double imag;
9315 @}
9316 @end group
9317 @end smallexample
9318
9319 @noindent
9320 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
9321 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
9322
9323 @kindex info types
9324 @item info types @var{regexp}
9325 @itemx info types
9326 Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
9327 (or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
9328 complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
9329 @samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
9330 names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
9331 information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
9332
9333 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
9334 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
9335 lists all source files where a type is defined.
9336
9337 @kindex info scope
9338 @cindex local variables
9339 @item info scope @var{addr}
9340 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
9341 accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
9342 preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
9343 scope defined by that location. For example:
9344
9345 @smallexample
9346 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
9347 Scope for command_line_handler:
9348 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
9349 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
9350 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
9351 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
9352 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
9353 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
9354 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
9355 @end smallexample
9356
9357 @noindent
9358 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
9359 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
9360 collect}.
9361
9362 @kindex info source
9363 @item info source
9364 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
9365 the function containing the current point of execution:
9366 @itemize @bullet
9367 @item
9368 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
9369 @item
9370 the directory it was compiled in,
9371 @item
9372 its length, in lines,
9373 @item
9374 which programming language it is written in,
9375 @item
9376 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
9377 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
9378 @item
9379 whether the debugging information includes information about
9380 preprocessor macros.
9381 @end itemize
9382
9383
9384 @kindex info sources
9385 @item info sources
9386 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
9387 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
9388 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
9389
9390 @kindex info functions
9391 @item info functions
9392 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
9393
9394 @item info functions @var{regexp}
9395 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
9396 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
9397 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
9398 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
9399 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
9400 that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
9401 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
9402
9403 @kindex info variables
9404 @item info variables
9405 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
9406 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
9407
9408 @item info variables @var{regexp}
9409 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
9410 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
9411 @var{regexp}.
9412
9413 @ignore
9414 This was never implemented.
9415 @kindex info methods
9416 @item info methods
9417 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
9418 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
9419 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
9420 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
9421 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
9422 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
9423 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
9424 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
9425 @end ignore
9426
9427 @cindex reloading symbols
9428 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
9429 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
9430 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
9431 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
9432 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
9433
9434 @table @code
9435 @kindex set symbol-reloading
9436 @item set symbol-reloading on
9437 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
9438 object file with a particular name is seen again.
9439
9440 @item set symbol-reloading off
9441 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
9442 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
9443 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
9444 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
9445 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
9446 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
9447 name.
9448
9449 @kindex show symbol-reloading
9450 @item show symbol-reloading
9451 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
9452 @end table
9453
9454 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
9455 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
9456 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
9457 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
9458 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
9459 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
9460 another source file. The default is on.
9461
9462 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
9463 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
9464
9465 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
9466 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
9467 is printed as follows:
9468 @smallexample
9469 @{<no data fields>@}
9470 @end smallexample
9471
9472 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
9473 @item show opaque-type-resolution
9474 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
9475
9476 @kindex maint print symbols
9477 @cindex symbol dump
9478 @kindex maint print psymbols
9479 @cindex partial symbol dump
9480 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
9481 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
9482 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
9483 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
9484 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
9485 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
9486 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
9487 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
9488 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
9489 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
9490 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
9491 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
9492 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
9493 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
9494 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
9495 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
9496 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
9497 @end table
9498
9499 @node Altering
9500 @chapter Altering Execution
9501
9502 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
9503 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
9504 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
9505 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
9506 program.
9507
9508 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
9509 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
9510 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
9511
9512 @menu
9513 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
9514 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
9515 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
9516 * Returning:: Returning from a function
9517 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
9518 * Patching:: Patching your program
9519 @end menu
9520
9521 @node Assignment
9522 @section Assignment to variables
9523
9524 @cindex assignment
9525 @cindex setting variables
9526 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
9527 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
9528
9529 @smallexample
9530 print x=4
9531 @end smallexample
9532
9533 @noindent
9534 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
9535 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
9536 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
9537 information on operators in supported languages.
9538
9539 @kindex set variable
9540 @cindex variables, setting
9541 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
9542 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
9543 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
9544 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
9545 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
9546
9547 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
9548 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
9549 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
9550 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
9551 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
9552 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
9553 command @code{set width}:
9554
9555 @smallexample
9556 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
9557 type = double
9558 (@value{GDBP}) p width
9559 $4 = 13
9560 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
9561 Invalid syntax in expression.
9562 @end smallexample
9563
9564 @noindent
9565 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
9566 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
9567
9568 @smallexample
9569 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
9570 @end smallexample
9571
9572 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
9573 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
9574 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
9575 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
9576 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
9577 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
9578
9579 @smallexample
9580 @group
9581 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
9582 type = double
9583 (@value{GDBP}) p g
9584 $1 = 1
9585 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
9586 (@value{GDBP}) p g
9587 $2 = 1
9588 (@value{GDBP}) r
9589 The program being debugged has been started already.
9590 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
9591 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
9592 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
9593 Invalid bfd target.
9594 (@value{GDBP}) show g
9595 The current BFD target is "=4".
9596 @end group
9597 @end smallexample
9598
9599 @noindent
9600 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
9601 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
9602 @code{g}, use
9603
9604 @smallexample
9605 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
9606 @end smallexample
9607
9608 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
9609 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
9610 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
9611 same length or shorter.
9612 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9613 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9614
9615 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9616 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9617 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9618 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9619 and representation in memory), and
9620
9621 @smallexample
9622 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
9623 @end smallexample
9624
9625 @noindent
9626 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9627
9628 @node Jumping
9629 @section Continuing at a different address
9630
9631 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9632 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9633 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9634
9635 @table @code
9636 @kindex jump
9637 @item jump @var{linespec}
9638 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9639 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9640 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9641 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9642 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9643 breakpoints}.
9644
9645 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9646 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9647 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9648 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9649 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9650 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9651 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9652 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9653 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9654
9655 @item jump *@var{address}
9656 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9657 @end table
9658
9659 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
9660 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9661 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9662 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9663 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9664 example,
9665
9666 @smallexample
9667 set $pc = 0x485
9668 @end smallexample
9669
9670 @noindent
9671 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9672 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9673 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
9674
9675 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9676 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9677 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9678 detail.
9679
9680 @c @group
9681 @node Signaling
9682 @section Giving your program a signal
9683
9684 @table @code
9685 @kindex signal
9686 @item signal @var{signal}
9687 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9688 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9689 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9690 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9691
9692 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9693 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9694 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9695 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9696 signal.
9697
9698 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9699 after executing the command.
9700 @end table
9701 @c @end group
9702
9703 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9704 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9705 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9706 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9707 passes the signal directly to your program.
9708
9709
9710 @node Returning
9711 @section Returning from a function
9712
9713 @table @code
9714 @cindex returning from a function
9715 @kindex return
9716 @item return
9717 @itemx return @var{expression}
9718 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9719 command. If you give an
9720 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9721 value.
9722 @end table
9723
9724 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9725 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9726 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9727 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9728
9729 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9730 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9731 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9732 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9733 of functions.
9734
9735 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9736 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9737 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9738 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9739 selected stack frame returns naturally.
9740
9741 @node Calling
9742 @section Calling program functions
9743
9744 @cindex calling functions
9745 @kindex call
9746 @table @code
9747 @item call @var{expr}
9748 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9749 returned values.
9750 @end table
9751
9752 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9753 execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
9754 with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9755 is printed and saved in the value history.
9756
9757 @node Patching
9758 @section Patching programs
9759
9760 @cindex patching binaries
9761 @cindex writing into executables
9762 @cindex writing into corefiles
9763
9764 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9765 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9766 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9767 patching your program's binary.
9768
9769 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9770 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9771 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9772 repairs.
9773
9774 @table @code
9775 @kindex set write
9776 @item set write on
9777 @itemx set write off
9778 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9779 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
9780 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9781
9782 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
9783 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9784 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
9785
9786 @item show write
9787 @kindex show write
9788 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9789 as well as reading.
9790 @end table
9791
9792 @node GDB Files
9793 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9794
9795 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9796 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9797 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9798 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
9799
9800 @menu
9801 * Files:: Commands to specify files
9802 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9803 @end menu
9804
9805 @node Files
9806 @section Commands to specify files
9807
9808 @cindex symbol table
9809 @cindex core dump file
9810
9811 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9812 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9813 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9814 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
9815
9816 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9817 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9818 a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9819 to specify new files are useful.
9820
9821 @table @code
9822 @cindex executable file
9823 @kindex file
9824 @item file @var{filename}
9825 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9826 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9827 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
9828 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9829 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9830 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9831 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
9832 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9833
9834 On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
9835 @file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9836 @var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9837 @file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9838 descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9839 (available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
9840 @code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
9841 for more information.
9842
9843 @item file
9844 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9845 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9846
9847 @kindex exec-file
9848 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9849 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9850 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9851 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9852 discard information on the executable file.
9853
9854 @kindex symbol-file
9855 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9856 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9857 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9858 table and program to run from the same file.
9859
9860 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9861 program's symbol table.
9862
9863 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
9864 of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9865 auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9866 the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9867 the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9868
9869 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9870 executing it once.
9871
9872 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9873 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9874 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9875 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
9876 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9877 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9878 optimized code.
9879
9880 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9881 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9882 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9883 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9884 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9885
9886 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9887 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9888 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9889 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9890 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9891 warnings and messages}.)
9892
9893 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9894 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9895 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9896 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9897 in stabs format.
9898
9899 @kindex readnow
9900 @cindex reading symbols immediately
9901 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
9902 @kindex mapped
9903 @cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9904 @cindex saving symbol table
9905 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9906 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9907 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9908 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9909 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
9910 entire symbol table available.
9911
9912 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9913 @code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9914 cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9915 file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9916 from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9917 than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9918 program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9919 starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9920
9921 You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9922 file has all the symbol information for your program.
9923
9924 The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9925 @samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9926 than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9927 it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9928 needed.
9929
9930 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9931 @value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9932 symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
9933
9934 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9935 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9936 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9937 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9938 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9939 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9940 @c files.
9941
9942 @kindex core
9943 @kindex core-file
9944 @item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9945 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9946 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9947 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9948 executable file itself for other parts.
9949
9950 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9951 to be used.
9952
9953 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
9954 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9955 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9956 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
9957 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
9958
9959 @kindex add-symbol-file
9960 @cindex dynamic linking
9961 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9962 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9963 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
9964 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9965 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9966 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9967 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9968 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
9969 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9970 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9971 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9972 @var{address} as an expression.
9973
9974 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9975 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
9976 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9977 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9978 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
9979
9980 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9981 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9982 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9983 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9984 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9985 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9986 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9987 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9988 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9989
9990 @itemize @bullet
9991 @item
9992 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9993 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9994 @item
9995 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9996 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9997 @item
9998 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9999 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
10000 @end itemize
10001
10002 @noindent
10003 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
10004 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
10005 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
10006 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
10007 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
10008 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
10009 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
10010 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
10011 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
10012 way.
10013
10014 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10015
10016 You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
10017 the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
10018 table information for @var{filename}.
10019
10020 @kindex add-shared-symbol-file
10021 @item add-shared-symbol-file
10022 The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
10023 operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
10024 shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
10025 @code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
10026
10027 @kindex section
10028 @item section
10029 The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
10030 the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
10031 section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
10032 specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
10033 separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
10034 the sections and their addresses.
10035
10036 @kindex info files
10037 @kindex info target
10038 @item info files
10039 @itemx info target
10040 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
10041 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
10042 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
10043 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
10044 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
10045 current ones.
10046
10047 @kindex maint info sections
10048 @item maint info sections
10049 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
10050 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
10051 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
10052 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
10053 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
10054 may be arbitrarily combined):
10055
10056 @table @code
10057 @item ALLOBJ
10058 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
10059 @item @var{sections}
10060 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
10061 @item @var{section-flags}
10062 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
10063 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
10064 @table @code
10065 @item ALLOC
10066 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
10067 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
10068 @item LOAD
10069 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
10070 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
10071 @item RELOC
10072 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
10073 @item READONLY
10074 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
10075 @item CODE
10076 Section contains executable code only.
10077 @item DATA
10078 Section contains data only (no executable code).
10079 @item ROM
10080 Section will reside in ROM.
10081 @item CONSTRUCTOR
10082 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
10083 @item HAS_CONTENTS
10084 Section is not empty.
10085 @item NEVER_LOAD
10086 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
10087 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
10088 A notification to the linker that the section contains
10089 COFF shared library information.
10090 @item IS_COMMON
10091 Section contains common symbols.
10092 @end table
10093 @end table
10094 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
10095 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
10096 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
10097 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
10098 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
10099 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
10100 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
10101 enhancement to debugging performance.
10102
10103 The default is off.
10104
10105 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
10106 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
10107 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
10108 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
10109 @end table
10110
10111 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
10112 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
10113 name and remembers it that way.
10114
10115 @cindex shared libraries
10116 @value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
10117 libraries.
10118
10119 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
10120 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
10121 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
10122 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
10123 debugging a core file).
10124
10125 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
10126 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
10127
10128 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
10129 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
10130 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
10131
10132 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
10133 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
10134 particularly large or there are many of them.
10135
10136 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
10137 commands:
10138
10139 @table @code
10140 @kindex set auto-solib-add
10141 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
10142 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
10143 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
10144 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
10145 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
10146 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
10147 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
10148
10149 @kindex show auto-solib-add
10150 @item show auto-solib-add
10151 Display the current autoloading mode.
10152 @end table
10153
10154 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
10155 command:
10156
10157 @table @code
10158 @kindex info sharedlibrary
10159 @kindex info share
10160 @item info share
10161 @itemx info sharedlibrary
10162 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
10163
10164 @kindex sharedlibrary
10165 @kindex share
10166 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
10167 @itemx share @var{regex}
10168 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
10169 Unix regular expression.
10170 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
10171 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
10172 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
10173 loaded.
10174 @end table
10175
10176 On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
10177 autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
10178 reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
10179 by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
10180 up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
10181 wish.
10182
10183 Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
10184 loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
10185 @var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
10186 automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
10187
10188 To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
10189
10190 @table @code
10191 @kindex set auto-solib-limit
10192 @item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
10193 Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
10194 If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
10195 symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
10196 size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
10197 Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
10198 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
10199 Mb).
10200
10201 @kindex show auto-solib-limit
10202 @item show auto-solib-limit
10203 Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
10204 @end table
10205
10206 @node Symbol Errors
10207 @section Errors reading symbol files
10208
10209 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
10210 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
10211 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
10212 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
10213 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
10214 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
10215 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
10216 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
10217 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
10218 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
10219 messages}).
10220
10221 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
10222
10223 @table @code
10224 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
10225
10226 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
10227 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
10228 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
10229 in its outer scope blocks.
10230
10231 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
10232 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
10233 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
10234 function.
10235
10236 @item block at @var{address} out of order
10237
10238 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
10239 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
10240 do so.
10241
10242 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
10243 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
10244 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
10245 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
10246 messages}.)
10247
10248 @item bad block start address patched
10249
10250 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
10251 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
10252 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
10253
10254 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
10255 starting on the previous source line.
10256
10257 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
10258
10259 @cindex foo
10260 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
10261 larger than the size of the string table.
10262
10263 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
10264 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
10265 with this name.
10266
10267 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
10268
10269 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
10270 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
10271 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
10272
10273 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
10274 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
10275 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
10276 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
10277 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
10278 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
10279
10280 @item stub type has NULL name
10281
10282 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
10283
10284 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
10285 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
10286 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
10287 it.
10288
10289 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
10290
10291 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
10292
10293 @end table
10294
10295 @node Targets
10296 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
10297
10298 @cindex debugging target
10299 @kindex target
10300
10301 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
10302
10303 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
10304 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
10305 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
10306 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
10307 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
10308 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
10309 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
10310 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
10311
10312 @menu
10313 * Active Targets:: Active targets
10314 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
10315 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
10316 * Remote:: Remote debugging
10317 * KOD:: Kernel Object Display
10318
10319 @end menu
10320
10321 @node Active Targets
10322 @section Active targets
10323
10324 @cindex stacking targets
10325 @cindex active targets
10326 @cindex multiple targets
10327
10328 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
10329 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
10330 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
10331 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
10332 a core file.
10333
10334 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
10335 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
10336 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
10337 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
10338 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
10339 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
10340 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
10341 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
10342 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
10343
10344 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
10345 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
10346 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
10347 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
10348 process target is active.
10349
10350 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
10351 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
10352 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
10353 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
10354 process}).
10355
10356 @node Target Commands
10357 @section Commands for managing targets
10358
10359 @table @code
10360 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
10361 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
10362 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
10363 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
10364 protocol of the target machine.
10365
10366 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
10367 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
10368 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
10369
10370 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
10371 after executing the command.
10372
10373 @kindex help target
10374 @item help target
10375 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
10376 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
10377 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10378
10379 @item help target @var{name}
10380 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
10381 select it.
10382
10383 @kindex set gnutarget
10384 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
10385 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
10386 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
10387 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
10388 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
10389 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
10390
10391 @quotation
10392 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
10393 you must know the actual BFD name.
10394 @end quotation
10395
10396 @noindent
10397 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
10398
10399 @kindex show gnutarget
10400 @item show gnutarget
10401 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
10402 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
10403 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
10404 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
10405 @end table
10406
10407 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
10408 configuration):
10409
10410 @table @code
10411 @kindex target exec
10412 @item target exec @var{program}
10413 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
10414 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
10415
10416 @kindex target core
10417 @item target core @var{filename}
10418 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
10419 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
10420
10421 @kindex target remote
10422 @item target remote @var{dev}
10423 Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
10424 specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
10425 @file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
10426 supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
10427 some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
10428 it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
10429
10430 @kindex target sim
10431 @item target sim
10432 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
10433 In general,
10434 @smallexample
10435 target sim
10436 load
10437 run
10438 @end smallexample
10439 @noindent
10440 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
10441 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
10442 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
10443 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
10444 Processors}.
10445
10446 @end table
10447
10448 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
10449
10450 @table @code
10451
10452 @kindex target nrom
10453 @item target nrom @var{dev}
10454 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
10455
10456 @end table
10457
10458 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
10459 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
10460
10461 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
10462 once you've successfully established a connection.
10463
10464 @table @code
10465
10466 @kindex load @var{filename}
10467 @item load @var{filename}
10468 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
10469 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
10470 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
10471 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
10472 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
10473 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
10474
10475 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
10476 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
10477 target is @dots{}}''
10478
10479 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
10480 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
10481 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
10482 specifies a fixed address.
10483 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
10484
10485 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10486 @end table
10487
10488 @node Byte Order
10489 @section Choosing target byte order
10490
10491 @cindex choosing target byte order
10492 @cindex target byte order
10493
10494 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
10495 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
10496 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
10497 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
10498 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
10499 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
10500
10501 @table @code
10502 @kindex set endian big
10503 @item set endian big
10504 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
10505
10506 @kindex set endian little
10507 @item set endian little
10508 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
10509
10510 @kindex set endian auto
10511 @item set endian auto
10512 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
10513 executable.
10514
10515 @item show endian
10516 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
10517
10518 @end table
10519
10520 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
10521 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
10522 target system.
10523
10524 @node Remote
10525 @section Remote debugging
10526 @cindex remote debugging
10527
10528 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
10529 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
10530 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
10531 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
10532 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
10533
10534 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
10535 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
10536 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
10537 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
10538 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
10539 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
10540
10541 Other remote targets may be available in your
10542 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
10543
10544 @node KOD
10545 @section Kernel Object Display
10546
10547 @cindex kernel object display
10548 @cindex kernel object
10549 @cindex KOD
10550
10551 Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10552 @value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10553 and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10554 mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10555 displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10556
10557 Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10558 @value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10559
10560 @smallexample
10561 (@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
10562 @end smallexample
10563
10564 If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10565 about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10566 which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10567 after the operating system:
10568
10569 @smallexample
10570 (@value{GDBP}) info cisco
10571 List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10572 Object Description
10573 any Any and all objects
10574 @end smallexample
10575
10576 Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10577 by the kernel.
10578
10579 There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
10580 is supported other than to try it.
10581
10582
10583 @node Remote Debugging
10584 @chapter Debugging remote programs
10585
10586 @menu
10587 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
10588 * NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
10589 * remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
10590 @end menu
10591
10592 @node Server
10593 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10594
10595 @kindex gdbserver
10596 @cindex remote connection without stubs
10597 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10598 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10599 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10600
10601 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10602 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10603 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10604 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10605 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10606 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10607 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10608 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10609 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10610 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10611 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10612 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10613 choice for debugging.
10614
10615 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10616 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10617 protocol.
10618
10619 @table @emph
10620 @item On the target machine,
10621 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10622 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10623 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10624 system does all the symbol handling.
10625
10626 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
10627 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
10628 syntax is:
10629
10630 @smallexample
10631 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10632 @end smallexample
10633
10634 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10635 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10636 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10637 @file{/dev/com1}:
10638
10639 @smallexample
10640 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10641 @end smallexample
10642
10643 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10644 with it.
10645
10646 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10647
10648 @smallexample
10649 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10650 @end smallexample
10651
10652 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10653 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10654 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10655 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10656 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10657 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10658 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10659 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10660 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10661 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10662 @code{target remote} command.
10663
10664 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
10665 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
10666
10667 @smallexample
10668 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
10669 @end smallexample
10670
10671 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
10672 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
10673
10674 @item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10675 you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10676 symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10677 using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10678 (You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10679 running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
10680 remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10681 is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10682 @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10683 @code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10684
10685 @smallexample
10686 (@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10687 @end smallexample
10688
10689 @noindent
10690 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10691
10692 @smallexample
10693 (@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10694 @end smallexample
10695
10696 @noindent
10697 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10698 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10699 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10700 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10701 @samp{Connection refused}.
10702 @end table
10703
10704 @node NetWare
10705 @section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10706
10707 @kindex gdbserve.nlm
10708 @code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10709 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10710 @code{target remote}.
10711
10712 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10713 using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10714
10715 @table @emph
10716 @item On the target machine,
10717 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10718 @code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10719 can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10720 host system does all the symbol handling.
10721
10722 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10723 @value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10724 program. The syntax is:
10725
10726 @smallexample
10727 load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10728 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10729 @end smallexample
10730
10731 @var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10732 the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10733 to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10734
10735 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10736 communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10737 using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10738
10739 @smallexample
10740 load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10741 @end smallexample
10742
10743 @item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10744 you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10745 symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10746 using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10747 (You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10748 running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
10749 remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10750 argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10751 @file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10752
10753 @smallexample
10754 (@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10755 @end smallexample
10756
10757 @noindent
10758 communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10759 @end table
10760
10761 @node remote stub
10762 @section Implementing a remote stub
10763
10764 @cindex debugging stub, example
10765 @cindex remote stub, example
10766 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
10767 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10768 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10769 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10770 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10771 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10772 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10773 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10774
10775 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10776 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10777 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10778 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10779 program, you need:
10780
10781 @enumerate
10782 @item
10783 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10784 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10785 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
10786
10787 @item
10788 A C subroutine library to support your program's
10789 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
10790
10791 @item
10792 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10793 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10794 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10795 documentation.
10796 @end enumerate
10797
10798 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10799 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10800 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
10801
10802 @table @emph
10803 @item On the host,
10804 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
10805 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
10806 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
10807
10808 @item On the target,
10809 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
10810 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
10811 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
10812
10813 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
10814 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
10815 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
10816 @end table
10817
10818 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
10819 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
10820 @sc{sparc} boards.
10821
10822 @cindex remote serial stub list
10823 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
10824
10825 @table @code
10826
10827 @item i386-stub.c
10828 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
10829 @cindex Intel
10830 @cindex i386
10831 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
10832
10833 @item m68k-stub.c
10834 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
10835 @cindex Motorola 680x0
10836 @cindex m680x0
10837 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
10838
10839 @item sh-stub.c
10840 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
10841 @cindex Hitachi
10842 @cindex SH
10843 For Hitachi SH architectures.
10844
10845 @item sparc-stub.c
10846 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
10847 @cindex Sparc
10848 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10849
10850 @item sparcl-stub.c
10851 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
10852 @cindex Fujitsu
10853 @cindex SparcLite
10854 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10855
10856 @end table
10857
10858 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
10859 recently added stubs.
10860
10861 @menu
10862 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
10863 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
10864 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
10865 @end menu
10866
10867 @node Stub Contents
10868 @subsection What the stub can do for you
10869
10870 @cindex remote serial stub
10871 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
10872 subroutines:
10873
10874 @table @code
10875 @item set_debug_traps
10876 @kindex set_debug_traps
10877 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
10878 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
10879 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
10880 beginning of your program.
10881
10882 @item handle_exception
10883 @kindex handle_exception
10884 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
10885 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
10886 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
10887 run when a trap is triggered.
10888
10889 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
10890 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
10891 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
10892 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
10893 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
10894 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
10895 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
10896 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
10897 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
10898 machine.
10899
10900 @item breakpoint
10901 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
10902 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
10903 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
10904 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
10905 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
10906 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
10907 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
10908 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
10909 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
10910 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
10911 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
10912
10913 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
10914 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
10915 start of your debugging session.
10916 @end table
10917
10918 @node Bootstrapping
10919 @subsection What you must do for the stub
10920
10921 @cindex remote stub, support routines
10922 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
10923 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
10924 debugging target machine.
10925
10926 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
10927 serial port.
10928
10929 @table @code
10930 @item int getDebugChar()
10931 @kindex getDebugChar
10932 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
10933 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
10934 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10935
10936 @item void putDebugChar(int)
10937 @kindex putDebugChar
10938 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
10939 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
10940 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10941 @end table
10942
10943 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
10944 @cindex interrupting remote targets
10945 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
10946 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
10947 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
10948 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
10949 remote system to stop.
10950
10951 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
10952 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
10953 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
10954 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
10955
10956 Other routines you need to supply are:
10957
10958 @table @code
10959 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
10960 @kindex exceptionHandler
10961 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
10962 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
10963 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
10964 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
10965 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
10966 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
10967 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
10968 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
10969 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
10970 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
10971 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
10972 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
10973 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
10974
10975 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
10976 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
10977 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
10978 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
10979 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
10980
10981 @item void flush_i_cache()
10982 @kindex flush_i_cache
10983 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
10984 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
10985 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
10986
10987 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
10988 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
10989 @end table
10990
10991 @noindent
10992 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
10993
10994 @table @code
10995 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
10996 @kindex memset
10997 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
10998 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
10999 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
11000 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
11001 @end table
11002
11003 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
11004 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
11005 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
11006 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
11007
11008
11009 @node Debug Session
11010 @subsection Putting it all together
11011
11012 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
11013 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
11014 steps.
11015
11016 @enumerate
11017 @item
11018 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
11019 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
11020 @display
11021 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
11022 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
11023 @end display
11024
11025 @item
11026 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
11027
11028 @smallexample
11029 set_debug_traps();
11030 breakpoint();
11031 @end smallexample
11032
11033 @item
11034 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
11035 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
11036
11037 @smallexample
11038 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
11039 @end smallexample
11040
11041 @noindent
11042 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
11043 function in your program, that function is called when
11044 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
11045 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
11046 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
11047
11048 @item
11049 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
11050 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
11051
11052 @item
11053 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
11054 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
11055
11056 @item
11057 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
11058 @c document that. FIXME.
11059 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
11060 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
11061
11062 @item
11063 To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
11064 as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
11065 This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
11066 of its pure text.
11067
11068 @item
11069 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
11070 Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
11071 Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
11072 machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
11073 TCP or UDP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
11074 to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
11075 device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
11076
11077 @smallexample
11078 target remote /dev/ttyb
11079 @end smallexample
11080
11081 @cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
11082 To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
11083 @code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
11084 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
11085 terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
11086
11087 @smallexample
11088 target remote manyfarms:2828
11089 @end smallexample
11090
11091 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
11092 your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
11093 the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
11094 to port 1234 on your local machine:
11095
11096 @smallexample
11097 target remote :1234
11098 @end smallexample
11099 @noindent
11100
11101 Note that the colon is still required here.
11102
11103 @cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
11104 To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
11105 @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
11106 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
11107
11108 @smallexample
11109 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
11110 @end smallexample
11111
11112 When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
11113 that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
11114 busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
11115 session.
11116
11117 @end enumerate
11118
11119 Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
11120 step and continue the remote program.
11121
11122 To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
11123 command.
11124
11125 @cindex interrupting remote programs
11126 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
11127 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
11128 interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
11129 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
11130 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
11131 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
11132
11133 @smallexample
11134 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
11135 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
11136 @end smallexample
11137
11138 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
11139 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
11140 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
11141 goes back to waiting.
11142
11143
11144 @node Configurations
11145 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
11146
11147 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
11148 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
11149 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
11150
11151 There are three major categories of configurations: native
11152 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
11153 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
11154 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
11155 are quite different from each other.
11156
11157 @menu
11158 * Native::
11159 * Embedded OS::
11160 * Embedded Processors::
11161 * Architectures::
11162 @end menu
11163
11164 @node Native
11165 @section Native
11166
11167 This section describes details specific to particular native
11168 configurations.
11169
11170 @menu
11171 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
11172 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
11173 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
11174 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
11175 @end menu
11176
11177 @node HP-UX
11178 @subsection HP-UX
11179
11180 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
11181 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
11182 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
11183
11184 @node SVR4 Process Information
11185 @subsection SVR4 process information
11186
11187 @kindex /proc
11188 @cindex process image
11189
11190 Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
11191 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
11192 subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
11193 this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
11194 several kinds of information about the process running your program.
11195 @code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
11196 @code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
11197 and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
11198
11199 @table @code
11200 @kindex info proc
11201 @item info proc
11202 Summarize available information about the process.
11203
11204 @kindex info proc mappings
11205 @item info proc mappings
11206 Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
11207 on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
11208 @ignore
11209 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
11210 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
11211 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
11212 @kindex info proc times
11213 @item info proc times
11214 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
11215 its children.
11216
11217 @kindex info proc id
11218 @item info proc id
11219 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
11220 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
11221
11222 @kindex info proc status
11223 @item info proc status
11224 General information on the state of the process. If the process is
11225 stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
11226 received.
11227
11228 @item info proc all
11229 Show all the above information about the process.
11230 @end ignore
11231 @end table
11232
11233 @node DJGPP Native
11234 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
11235 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
11236 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
11237 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
11238
11239 @sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
11240 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
11241 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
11242 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
11243
11244 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
11245 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
11246 subsection describes those commands.
11247
11248 @table @code
11249 @kindex info dos
11250 @item info dos
11251 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
11252 information about the target system and important OS structures.
11253
11254 @kindex sysinfo
11255 @cindex MS-DOS system info
11256 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
11257 @item info dos sysinfo
11258 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
11259 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
11260 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
11261
11262 @cindex GDT
11263 @cindex LDT
11264 @cindex IDT
11265 @cindex segment descriptor tables
11266 @cindex descriptor tables display
11267 @item info dos gdt
11268 @itemx info dos ldt
11269 @itemx info dos idt
11270 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
11271 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
11272 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
11273 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
11274 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
11275 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
11276 rights.
11277
11278 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
11279 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
11280 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
11281 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
11282 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
11283
11284 @cindex garbled pointers
11285 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
11286 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
11287 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
11288 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
11289 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
11290 debugged program's data segment:
11291
11292 @smallexample
11293 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
11294 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
11295 @end smallexample
11296
11297 @noindent
11298 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
11299 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
11300
11301 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
11302 @item info dos pde
11303 @itemx info dos pte
11304 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
11305 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
11306 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
11307 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
11308 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
11309 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
11310 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
11311 that is currently in use.
11312
11313 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
11314 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
11315 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
11316 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
11317 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
11318 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
11319 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
11320
11321 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
11322 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
11323 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
11324 controller.
11325
11326 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
11327
11328 @cindex physical address from linear address
11329 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
11330 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
11331 address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
11332 appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
11333 accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
11334 example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
11335 the variable @code{i} is stored:
11336
11337 @smallexample
11338 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
11339 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
11340 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
11341 @end smallexample
11342
11343 @noindent
11344 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
11345 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
11346 attributes of that page.
11347
11348 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
11349 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
11350 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
11351 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
11352 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
11353 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
11354
11355 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
11356 transfer buffer:
11357
11358 @smallexample
11359 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
11360 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
11361 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
11362 @end smallexample
11363
11364 @noindent
11365 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
11366 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
11367 this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
11368 mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
11369
11370 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
11371 @end table
11372
11373 @node Cygwin Native
11374 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
11375 @cindex MS Windows debugging
11376 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
11377 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
11378
11379 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, and
11380 defines a few commands specific to the Cygwin port. This
11381 subsection describes those commands.
11382
11383 @table @code
11384 @kindex info w32
11385 @item info w32
11386 This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
11387 information about the target system and important OS structures.
11388
11389 @item info w32 selector
11390 This command displays information returned by
11391 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
11392 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
11393 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
11394 Without argument, this command displays information
11395 about the the six segment registers.
11396
11397 @kindex info dll
11398 @item info dll
11399 This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
11400
11401 @kindex dll-symbols
11402 @item dll-symbols
11403 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
11404 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
11405
11406 @kindex set new-console
11407 @item set new-console @var{mode}
11408 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
11409 be started in a new console on next start.
11410 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
11411 be started in the same console as the debugger.
11412
11413 @kindex show new-console
11414 @item show new-console
11415 Displays whether a new console is used
11416 when the debuggee is started.
11417
11418 @kindex set new-group
11419 @item set new-group @var{mode}
11420 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
11421 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
11422 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
11423 Ctrl-C.
11424
11425 @kindex show new-group
11426 @item show new-group
11427 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
11428
11429 @kindex set debugevents
11430 @item set debugevents
11431 This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
11432
11433 @kindex set debugexec
11434 @item set debugexec
11435 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
11436 seen by the debugger.
11437
11438 @kindex set debugexceptions
11439 @item set debugexceptions
11440 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
11441 seen by the debugger.
11442
11443 @kindex set debugmemory
11444 @item set debugmemory
11445 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
11446 seen by the debugger.
11447
11448 @kindex set shell
11449 @item set shell
11450 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
11451 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
11452
11453 @kindex show shell
11454 @item show shell
11455 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
11456
11457 @end table
11458
11459 @node Embedded OS
11460 @section Embedded Operating Systems
11461
11462 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
11463 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
11464 architectures.
11465
11466 @menu
11467 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11468 @end menu
11469
11470 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
11471 various real-time operating systems.
11472
11473 @node VxWorks
11474 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11475
11476 @cindex VxWorks
11477
11478 @table @code
11479
11480 @kindex target vxworks
11481 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
11482 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
11483 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
11484
11485 @end table
11486
11487 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
11488 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
11489
11490 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
11491 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
11492 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11493 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
11494 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
11495 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
11496 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
11497
11498 @table @code
11499 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
11500 @kindex vxworks-timeout
11501 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
11502 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11503 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
11504 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
11505 of a thin network line.
11506 @end table
11507
11508 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11509 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11510 procedures.
11511
11512 @kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11513 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11514 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11515 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11516 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11517 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11518 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11519 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11520 manual.
11521 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
11522
11523 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11524 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11525 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11526 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
11527
11528 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11529
11530 @smallexample
11531 (vxgdb)
11532 @end smallexample
11533
11534 @menu
11535 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11536 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11537 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11538 @end menu
11539
11540 @node VxWorks Connection
11541 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
11542
11543 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11544 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
11545
11546 @smallexample
11547 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
11548 @end smallexample
11549
11550 @need 750
11551 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11552
11553 @smallexample
11554 Attaching remote machine across net...
11555 Connected to tt.
11556 @end smallexample
11557
11558 @need 1000
11559 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11560 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11561 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11562 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11563 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
11564
11565 @smallexample
11566 prog.o: No such file or directory.
11567 @end smallexample
11568
11569 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11570 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11571 command again.
11572
11573 @node VxWorks Download
11574 @subsubsection VxWorks download
11575
11576 @cindex download to VxWorks
11577 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11578 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11579 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11580 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11581 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11582 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11583 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11584 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11585 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11586 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11587 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11588 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11589 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11590 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11591 program, type this on VxWorks:
11592
11593 @smallexample
11594 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
11595 @end smallexample
11596
11597 @noindent
11598 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11599
11600 @smallexample
11601 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
11602 (vxgdb) load prog.o
11603 @end smallexample
11604
11605 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
11606
11607 @smallexample
11608 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11609 @end smallexample
11610
11611 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11612 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11613 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11614 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11615 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
11616 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
11617 table.)
11618
11619 @node VxWorks Attach
11620 @subsubsection Running tasks
11621
11622 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
11623 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11624 follows:
11625
11626 @smallexample
11627 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
11628 @end smallexample
11629
11630 @noindent
11631 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11632 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11633 the time of attachment.
11634
11635 @node Embedded Processors
11636 @section Embedded Processors
11637
11638 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11639 configurations.
11640
11641
11642 @menu
11643 * ARM:: ARM
11644 * H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11645 * H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
11646 * i960:: Intel i960
11647 * M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11648 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
11649 @c OBSOLETE * M88K:: Motorola M88K
11650 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
11651 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
11652 * PowerPC: PowerPC
11653 * SH:: Hitachi SH
11654 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11655 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11656 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11657 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11658 @end menu
11659
11660 @node ARM
11661 @subsection ARM
11662
11663 @table @code
11664
11665 @kindex target rdi
11666 @item target rdi @var{dev}
11667 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11668 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11669 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11670
11671 @kindex target rdp
11672 @item target rdp @var{dev}
11673 ARM Demon monitor.
11674
11675 @end table
11676
11677 @node H8/300
11678 @subsection Hitachi H8/300
11679
11680 @table @code
11681
11682 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11683 @item target hms @var{dev}
11684 A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11685 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11686 line and the communications speed used.
11687
11688 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11689 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
11690 E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11691
11692 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11693 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11694 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
11695 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11696 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11697
11698 @end table
11699
11700 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11701 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11702 @cindex download to Hitachi SH
11703 @cindex Hitachi SH download
11704 When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11705 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11706 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11707 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11708
11709 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11710 Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11711
11712 @enumerate
11713 @item
11714 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11715 for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11716 emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11717 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11718 H8/300, or H8/500.)
11719
11720 @item
11721 what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11722 serial device available on your host is the default).
11723
11724 @item
11725 what speed to use over the serial device.
11726 @end enumerate
11727
11728 @menu
11729 * Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11730 * Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11731 * Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11732 @end menu
11733
11734 @node Hitachi Boards
11735 @subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11736
11737 @c only for Unix hosts
11738 @kindex device
11739 @cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11740 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11741 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11742 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11743 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11744
11745 @kindex speed
11746 @cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11747 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11748 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11749 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11750 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11751 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11752
11753 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11754 use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11755 use a DOS host,
11756 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11757 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11758 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11759 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11760
11761 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11762 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11763 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11764 the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11765
11766 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11767 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11768 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11769 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11770 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11771 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11772 @code{COM2}.
11773
11774 @smallexample
11775 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11776 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11777
11778 Resident portion of MODE loaded
11779
11780 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11781
11782 @end smallexample
11783
11784 @quotation
11785 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11786 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11787 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11788 your development board.
11789 @end quotation
11790
11791 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11792 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11793 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11794 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11795 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11796 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11797 cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11798 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11799 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11800 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11801 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11802 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11803 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11804
11805 @smallexample
11806 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11807 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11808 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11809 the conditions.
11810 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11811 for details.
11812 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11813 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
11814 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11815 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11816 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11817 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11818 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11819 @end smallexample
11820
11821 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11822 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11823 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11824 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11825 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11826 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11827
11828 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11829 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11830 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11831
11832 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11833 @itemize @bullet
11834 @item
11835 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11836 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11837
11838 @item
11839 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11840 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11841 to detect program completion.
11842 @end itemize
11843
11844 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11845 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11846
11847 @node Hitachi ICE
11848 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11849
11850 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11851 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11852 Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11853 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11854
11855 @table @code
11856 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11857 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11858 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11859 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11860 (for example, @samp{9600}).
11861
11862 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11863 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11864 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11865 @end table
11866
11867 @node Hitachi Special
11868 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11869
11870 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11871
11872 @table @code
11873
11874 @kindex set machine
11875 @kindex show machine
11876 @item set machine h8300
11877 @itemx set machine h8300h
11878 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11879 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11880 to check which variant is currently in effect.
11881
11882 @end table
11883
11884 @node H8/500
11885 @subsection H8/500
11886
11887 @table @code
11888
11889 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
11890 @cindex memory models, H8/500
11891 @item set memory @var{mod}
11892 @itemx show memory
11893 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11894 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11895 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11896 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
11897
11898 @end table
11899
11900 @node i960
11901 @subsection Intel i960
11902
11903 @table @code
11904
11905 @kindex target mon960
11906 @item target mon960 @var{dev}
11907 MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
11908
11909 @kindex target nindy
11910 @item target nindy @var{devicename}
11911 An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
11912 the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11913 @file{/dev/ttya}.
11914
11915 @end table
11916
11917 @cindex Nindy
11918 @cindex i960
11919 @dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
11920 @value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11921 tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11922
11923 @itemize @bullet
11924 @item
11925 Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11926 Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
11927
11928 @item
11929 By responding to a prompt on startup;
11930
11931 @item
11932 By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11933 session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11934
11935 @end itemize
11936
11937 @cindex download to Nindy-960
11938 With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11939 downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11940 @value{GDBN}.
11941
11942 @menu
11943 * Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
11944 * Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
11945 * Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
11946 @end menu
11947
11948 @node Nindy Startup
11949 @subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11950
11951 If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11952 options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11953 reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11954
11955 @smallexample
11956 Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
11957 @end smallexample
11958
11959 @noindent
11960 Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11961 identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
11962 simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11963 with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11964 use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11965
11966 @node Nindy Options
11967 @subsubsection Options for Nindy
11968
11969 These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11970 Nindy-960 board attached:
11971
11972 @table @code
11973 @item -r @var{port}
11974 Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11975 to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11976 configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
11977 @var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11978 device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11979 suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11980
11981 @item -O
11982 (An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11983 the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11984 This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11985 target architecture.
11986
11987 @quotation
11988 @emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11989 connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11990 fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11991 attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
11992 this process with an interrupt.
11993 @end quotation
11994
11995 @item -brk
11996 Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11997 system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
11998
11999 @quotation
12000 @emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
12001 requires; it only works with a few boards.
12002 @end quotation
12003 @end table
12004
12005 The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
12006 port.
12007
12008 @c @group
12009 @node Nindy Reset
12010 @subsubsection Nindy reset command
12011
12012 @table @code
12013 @item reset
12014 @kindex reset
12015 For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
12016 system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
12017 circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
12018 a break is detected.
12019 @end table
12020 @c @end group
12021
12022 @node M32R/D
12023 @subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
12024
12025 @table @code
12026
12027 @kindex target m32r
12028 @item target m32r @var{dev}
12029 Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
12030
12031 @end table
12032
12033 @node M68K
12034 @subsection M68k
12035
12036 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
12037 target command for the following ROM monitors.
12038
12039 @table @code
12040
12041 @kindex target abug
12042 @item target abug @var{dev}
12043 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
12044
12045 @kindex target cpu32bug
12046 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
12047 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
12048
12049 @kindex target dbug
12050 @item target dbug @var{dev}
12051 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
12052
12053 @kindex target est
12054 @item target est @var{dev}
12055 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
12056
12057 @kindex target rom68k
12058 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
12059 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
12060
12061 @end table
12062
12063 If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
12064 instead have only a single special target command:
12065
12066 @table @code
12067
12068 @kindex target es1800
12069 @item target es1800 @var{dev}
12070 ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
12071
12072 @end table
12073
12074 [context?]
12075
12076 @table @code
12077
12078 @kindex target rombug
12079 @item target rombug @var{dev}
12080 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
12081
12082 @end table
12083
12084 @c OBSOLETE @node M88K
12085 @c OBSOLETE @subsection M88K
12086 @c OBSOLETE
12087 @c OBSOLETE @table @code
12088 @c OBSOLETE
12089 @c OBSOLETE @kindex target bug
12090 @c OBSOLETE @item target bug @var{dev}
12091 @c OBSOLETE BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
12092 @c OBSOLETE
12093 @c OBSOLETE @end table
12094
12095 @node MIPS Embedded
12096 @subsection MIPS Embedded
12097
12098 @cindex MIPS boards
12099 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
12100 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
12101 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
12102
12103 @need 1000
12104 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
12105
12106 @table @code
12107 @item target mips @var{port}
12108 @kindex target mips @var{port}
12109 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
12110 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
12111 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
12112 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
12113 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
12114 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
12115
12116 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
12117 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
12118 debugger:
12119
12120 @smallexample
12121 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
12122 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
12123 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
12124 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
12125 (@value{GDBP}) run
12126 @end smallexample
12127
12128 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
12129 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
12130 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
12131 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
12132 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12133
12134 @item target pmon @var{port}
12135 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
12136 PMON ROM monitor.
12137
12138 @item target ddb @var{port}
12139 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
12140 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
12141
12142 @item target lsi @var{port}
12143 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
12144 LSI variant of PMON.
12145
12146 @kindex target r3900
12147 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
12148 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
12149
12150 @kindex target array
12151 @item target array @var{dev}
12152 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
12153
12154 @end table
12155
12156
12157 @noindent
12158 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
12159
12160 @table @code
12161 @item set processor @var{args}
12162 @itemx show processor
12163 @kindex set processor @var{args}
12164 @kindex show processor
12165 Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
12166 processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
12167 For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
12168 to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
12169 Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
12170 is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
12171 @value{GDBN} is using.
12172
12173 @item set mipsfpu double
12174 @itemx set mipsfpu single
12175 @itemx set mipsfpu none
12176 @itemx show mipsfpu
12177 @kindex set mipsfpu
12178 @kindex show mipsfpu
12179 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
12180 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
12181 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
12182 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
12183 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
12184 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
12185 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
12186 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
12187 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
12188 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
12189 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
12190 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
12191 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
12192
12193 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
12194 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
12195 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
12196
12197 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
12198 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
12199
12200 @item set remotedebug @var{n}
12201 @itemx show remotedebug
12202 @kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
12203 @kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
12204 @cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
12205 @cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
12206 @c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
12207 @c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
12208 You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
12209 by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
12210 @samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
12211 to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
12212 at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
12213
12214 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
12215 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
12216 @itemx show timeout
12217 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
12218 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
12219 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
12220 @kindex set timeout
12221 @kindex show timeout
12222 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
12223 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
12224 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
12225 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
12226 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
12227 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
12228 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
12229 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
12230 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
12231 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
12232
12233 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
12234 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
12235 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
12236 to run before stopping.
12237 @end table
12238
12239 @node PowerPC
12240 @subsection PowerPC
12241
12242 @table @code
12243
12244 @kindex target dink32
12245 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
12246 DINK32 ROM monitor.
12247
12248 @kindex target ppcbug
12249 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
12250 @kindex target ppcbug1
12251 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
12252 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
12253
12254 @kindex target sds
12255 @item target sds @var{dev}
12256 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
12257
12258 @end table
12259
12260 @node PA
12261 @subsection HP PA Embedded
12262
12263 @table @code
12264
12265 @kindex target op50n
12266 @item target op50n @var{dev}
12267 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
12268
12269 @kindex target w89k
12270 @item target w89k @var{dev}
12271 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
12272
12273 @end table
12274
12275 @node SH
12276 @subsection Hitachi SH
12277
12278 @table @code
12279
12280 @kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
12281 @item target hms @var{dev}
12282 A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
12283 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
12284 the communications speed used.
12285
12286 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
12287 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
12288 E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
12289
12290 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
12291 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
12292 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
12293 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
12294 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
12295
12296 @end table
12297
12298 @node Sparclet
12299 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
12300
12301 @cindex Sparclet
12302
12303 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
12304 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
12305 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
12306 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
12307 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
12308
12309 @table @code
12310 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
12311 @kindex remotetimeout
12312 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
12313 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
12314 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
12315 @end table
12316
12317 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
12318 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
12319 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
12320 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
12321 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
12322
12323 @smallexample
12324 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
12325 @end smallexample
12326
12327 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
12328
12329 @smallexample
12330 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
12331 @end smallexample
12332
12333 @cindex running, on Sparclet
12334 Once you have set
12335 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
12336 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
12337 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
12338
12339 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
12340
12341 @smallexample
12342 (gdbslet)
12343 @end smallexample
12344
12345 @menu
12346 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
12347 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
12348 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
12349 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
12350 @end menu
12351
12352 @node Sparclet File
12353 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
12354
12355 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
12356
12357 @smallexample
12358 (gdbslet) file prog
12359 @end smallexample
12360
12361 @need 1000
12362 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
12363 @value{GDBN} locates
12364 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
12365 path.
12366 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
12367 files will be searched as well.
12368 @value{GDBN} locates
12369 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
12370 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
12371 If it fails
12372 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
12373
12374 @smallexample
12375 prog: No such file or directory.
12376 @end smallexample
12377
12378 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
12379 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
12380 @code{target} command again.
12381
12382 @node Sparclet Connection
12383 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
12384
12385 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12386 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
12387
12388 @smallexample
12389 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12390 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
12391 main () at ../prog.c:3
12392 @end smallexample
12393
12394 @need 750
12395 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
12396
12397 @smallexample
12398 Connected to ttya.
12399 @end smallexample
12400
12401 @node Sparclet Download
12402 @subsubsection Sparclet download
12403
12404 @cindex download to Sparclet
12405 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
12406 you can use the @value{GDBN}
12407 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12408 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12409 command.
12410 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
12411 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
12412 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12413 of each of the file's sections.
12414 For instance, if the program
12415 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12416 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
12417
12418 @smallexample
12419 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12420 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
12421 @end smallexample
12422
12423 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12424 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12425 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12426
12427 @node Sparclet Execution
12428 @subsubsection Running and debugging
12429
12430 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12431 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12432 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
12433 manual for the list of commands.
12434
12435 @smallexample
12436 (gdbslet) b main
12437 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12438 (gdbslet) run
12439 Starting program: prog
12440 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
12441 3 char *symarg = 0;
12442 (gdbslet) step
12443 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
12444 (gdbslet)
12445 @end smallexample
12446
12447 @node Sparclite
12448 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
12449
12450 @table @code
12451
12452 @kindex target sparclite
12453 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
12454 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12455 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12456 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12457 remote protocol.
12458
12459 @end table
12460
12461 @node ST2000
12462 @subsection Tandem ST2000
12463
12464 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12465 STDBUG protocol.
12466
12467 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12468 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
12469
12470 @smallexample
12471 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
12472 @end smallexample
12473
12474 @noindent
12475 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12476 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12477 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12478 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12479 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12480
12481 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12482 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12483 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12484 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12485 available on your host computer.
12486 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12487 @c basically hearsay.
12488
12489 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12490 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12491 environment:
12492
12493 @table @code
12494 @item st2000 @var{command}
12495 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12496 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12497 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12498 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12499 manual for available commands.
12500
12501 @item connect
12502 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12503 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12504 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12505 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12506 @kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12507 @kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
12508 @end table
12509
12510 @node Z8000
12511 @subsection Zilog Z8000
12512
12513 @cindex Z8000
12514 @cindex simulator, Z8000
12515 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
12516
12517 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12518 a Z8000 simulator.
12519
12520 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12521 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12522 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12523 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
12524
12525 @table @code
12526 @item target sim @var{args}
12527 @kindex sim
12528 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12529 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12530 options, specify them via @var{args}.
12531 @end table
12532
12533 @noindent
12534 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12535 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12536 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12537 to run your program, and so on.
12538
12539 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12540 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12541 additional items of information as specially named registers:
12542
12543 @table @code
12544
12545 @item cycles
12546 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
12547
12548 @item insts
12549 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
12550
12551 @item time
12552 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
12553
12554 @end table
12555
12556 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12557 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12558 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12559 simulated clock ticks.
12560
12561 @node Architectures
12562 @section Architectures
12563
12564 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12565 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
12566
12567 @menu
12568 * A29K::
12569 * Alpha::
12570 * MIPS::
12571 @end menu
12572
12573 @node A29K
12574 @subsection A29K
12575
12576 @table @code
12577
12578 @kindex set rstack_high_address
12579 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
12580 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
12581 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12582 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12583 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12584 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12585 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12586 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12587 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12588 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12589 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12590 hexadecimal.
12591
12592 @kindex show rstack_high_address
12593 @item show rstack_high_address
12594 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12595 processors.
12596
12597 @end table
12598
12599 @node Alpha
12600 @subsection Alpha
12601
12602 See the following section.
12603
12604 @node MIPS
12605 @subsection MIPS
12606
12607 @cindex stack on Alpha
12608 @cindex stack on MIPS
12609 @cindex Alpha stack
12610 @cindex MIPS stack
12611 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12612 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12613 find the beginning of a function.
12614
12615 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12616 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12617 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12618 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12619 commands:
12620
12621 @table @code
12622 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12623 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12624 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12625 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12626 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12627 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12628 and therefore the longer it takes to run.
12629
12630 @item show heuristic-fence-post
12631 Display the current limit.
12632 @end table
12633
12634 @noindent
12635 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12636 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
12637
12638
12639 @node Controlling GDB
12640 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12641
12642 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12643 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12644 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12645 described here.
12646
12647 @menu
12648 * Prompt:: Prompt
12649 * Editing:: Command editing
12650 * History:: Command history
12651 * Screen Size:: Screen size
12652 * Numbers:: Numbers
12653 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12654 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12655 @end menu
12656
12657 @node Prompt
12658 @section Prompt
12659
12660 @cindex prompt
12661
12662 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12663 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12664 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12665 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12666 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12667 which one you are talking to.
12668
12669 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12670 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12671 or a prompt that does not.
12672
12673 @table @code
12674 @kindex set prompt
12675 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12676 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
12677
12678 @kindex show prompt
12679 @item show prompt
12680 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
12681 @end table
12682
12683 @node Editing
12684 @section Command editing
12685 @cindex readline
12686 @cindex command line editing
12687
12688 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12689 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12690 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12691 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12692 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12693 debugging sessions.
12694
12695 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12696 command @code{set}.
12697
12698 @table @code
12699 @kindex set editing
12700 @cindex editing
12701 @item set editing
12702 @itemx set editing on
12703 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
12704
12705 @item set editing off
12706 Disable command line editing.
12707
12708 @kindex show editing
12709 @item show editing
12710 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
12711 @end table
12712
12713 @node History
12714 @section Command history
12715
12716 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12717 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12718 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12719 history facility.
12720
12721 @table @code
12722 @cindex history substitution
12723 @cindex history file
12724 @kindex set history filename
12725 @kindex GDBHISTFILE
12726 @item set history filename @var{fname}
12727 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12728 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12729 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12730 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12731 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12732 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12733 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12734 is not set.
12735
12736 @cindex history save
12737 @kindex set history save
12738 @item set history save
12739 @itemx set history save on
12740 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12741 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
12742
12743 @item set history save off
12744 Stop recording command history in a file.
12745
12746 @cindex history size
12747 @kindex set history size
12748 @item set history size @var{size}
12749 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12750 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12751 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
12752 @end table
12753
12754 @cindex history expansion
12755 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12756 @ifset have-readline-appendices
12757 @xref{Event Designators}.
12758 @end ifset
12759
12760 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12761 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12762 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12763 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12764 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12765 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12766 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12767
12768 The commands to control history expansion are:
12769
12770 @table @code
12771 @kindex set history expansion
12772 @item set history expansion on
12773 @itemx set history expansion
12774 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
12775
12776 @item set history expansion off
12777 Disable history expansion.
12778
12779 The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12780 editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12781 or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12782 @ifset have-readline-appendices
12783 @xref{Command Line Editing}.
12784 @end ifset
12785
12786 @c @group
12787 @kindex show history
12788 @item show history
12789 @itemx show history filename
12790 @itemx show history save
12791 @itemx show history size
12792 @itemx show history expansion
12793 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12794 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12795 @c @end group
12796 @end table
12797
12798 @table @code
12799 @kindex shows
12800 @item show commands
12801 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
12802
12803 @item show commands @var{n}
12804 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12805
12806 @item show commands +
12807 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
12808 @end table
12809
12810 @node Screen Size
12811 @section Screen size
12812 @cindex size of screen
12813 @cindex pauses in output
12814
12815 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12816 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12817 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12818 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12819 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12820 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12821 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12822 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12823
12824 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12825 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12826 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12827 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12828 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12829 width} commands:
12830
12831 @table @code
12832 @kindex set height
12833 @kindex set width
12834 @kindex show width
12835 @kindex show height
12836 @item set height @var{lpp}
12837 @itemx show height
12838 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
12839 @itemx show width
12840 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12841 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12842 commands display the current settings.
12843
12844 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12845 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
12846 file or to an editor buffer.
12847
12848 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12849 from wrapping its output.
12850 @end table
12851
12852 @node Numbers
12853 @section Numbers
12854 @cindex number representation
12855 @cindex entering numbers
12856
12857 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12858 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12859 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12860 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12861 default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12862 numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12863 change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12864 radix} command.
12865
12866 @table @code
12867 @kindex set input-radix
12868 @item set input-radix @var{base}
12869 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12870 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12871 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12872 example, any of
12873
12874 @smallexample
12875 set radix 012
12876 set radix 10.
12877 set radix 0xa
12878 @end smallexample
12879
12880 @noindent
12881 sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12882 leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
12883
12884 @kindex set output-radix
12885 @item set output-radix @var{base}
12886 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12887 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12888 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
12889
12890 @kindex show input-radix
12891 @item show input-radix
12892 Display the current default base for numeric input.
12893
12894 @kindex show output-radix
12895 @item show output-radix
12896 Display the current default base for numeric display.
12897 @end table
12898
12899 @node Messages/Warnings
12900 @section Optional warnings and messages
12901
12902 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12903 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12904 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12905 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
12906
12907 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12908 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12909 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
12910
12911 @table @code
12912 @kindex set verbose
12913 @item set verbose on
12914 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12915
12916 @item set verbose off
12917 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12918
12919 @kindex show verbose
12920 @item show verbose
12921 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12922 @end table
12923
12924 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12925 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12926 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12927 symbol files}).
12928
12929 @table @code
12930
12931 @kindex set complaints
12932 @item set complaints @var{limit}
12933 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12934 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12935 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12936 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
12937
12938 @kindex show complaints
12939 @item show complaints
12940 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
12941
12942 @end table
12943
12944 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12945 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12946 you try to run a program which is already running:
12947
12948 @smallexample
12949 (@value{GDBP}) run
12950 The program being debugged has been started already.
12951 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
12952 @end smallexample
12953
12954 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12955 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
12956
12957 @table @code
12958
12959 @kindex set confirm
12960 @cindex flinching
12961 @cindex confirmation
12962 @cindex stupid questions
12963 @item set confirm off
12964 Disables confirmation requests.
12965
12966 @item set confirm on
12967 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
12968
12969 @kindex show confirm
12970 @item show confirm
12971 Displays state of confirmation requests.
12972
12973 @end table
12974
12975 @node Debugging Output
12976 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
12977 @table @code
12978 @kindex set debug arch
12979 @item set debug arch
12980 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12981 @kindex show debug arch
12982 @item show debug arch
12983 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12984 @kindex set debug event
12985 @item set debug event
12986 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12987 default is off.
12988 @kindex show debug event
12989 @item show debug event
12990 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12991 info.
12992 @kindex set debug expression
12993 @item set debug expression
12994 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12995 default is off.
12996 @kindex show debug expression
12997 @item show debug expression
12998 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12999 debugging info.
13000 @kindex set debug overload
13001 @item set debug overload
13002 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
13003 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
13004 is off.
13005 @kindex show debug overload
13006 @item show debug overload
13007 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
13008 debugging info.
13009 @kindex set debug remote
13010 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
13011 @cindex serial connections, debugging
13012 @item set debug remote
13013 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
13014 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
13015 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
13016 @kindex show debug remote
13017 @item show debug remote
13018 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
13019 @kindex set debug serial
13020 @item set debug serial
13021 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
13022 default is off.
13023 @kindex show debug serial
13024 @item show debug serial
13025 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
13026 info.
13027 @kindex set debug target
13028 @item set debug target
13029 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
13030 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
13031 default is off.
13032 @kindex show debug target
13033 @item show debug target
13034 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
13035 info.
13036 @kindex set debug varobj
13037 @item set debug varobj
13038 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
13039 info. The default is off.
13040 @kindex show debug varobj
13041 @item show debug varobj
13042 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
13043 debugging info.
13044 @end table
13045
13046 @node Sequences
13047 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
13048
13049 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
13050 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
13051 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
13052 files.
13053
13054 @menu
13055 * Define:: User-defined commands
13056 * Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
13057 * Command Files:: Command files
13058 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
13059 @end menu
13060
13061 @node Define
13062 @section User-defined commands
13063
13064 @cindex user-defined command
13065 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
13066 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
13067 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
13068 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
13069 via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
13070
13071 @smallexample
13072 define adder
13073 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
13074 @end smallexample
13075
13076 @noindent
13077 To execute the command use:
13078
13079 @smallexample
13080 adder 1 2 3
13081 @end smallexample
13082
13083 @noindent
13084 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
13085 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
13086 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
13087 functions calls.
13088
13089 @table @code
13090
13091 @kindex define
13092 @item define @var{commandname}
13093 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
13094 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
13095
13096 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
13097 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
13098 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
13099
13100 @kindex if
13101 @kindex else
13102 @item if
13103 Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
13104 It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
13105 only if the expression is true (nonzero).
13106 There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
13107 by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
13108 was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
13109
13110 @kindex while
13111 @item while
13112 The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
13113 which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
13114 execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
13115 The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
13116 evaluates to true.
13117
13118 @kindex document
13119 @item document @var{commandname}
13120 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
13121 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
13122 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
13123 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
13124 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
13125 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
13126
13127 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
13128 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
13129 does not change the documentation.
13130
13131 @kindex help user-defined
13132 @item help user-defined
13133 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
13134 (if any) for each.
13135
13136 @kindex show user
13137 @item show user
13138 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
13139 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
13140 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
13141 definitions for all user-defined commands.
13142
13143 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
13144 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
13145 @item show max-user-call-depth
13146 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
13147 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
13148 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
13149 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
13150
13151 @end table
13152
13153 When user-defined commands are executed, the
13154 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
13155 stops execution of the user-defined command.
13156
13157 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
13158 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
13159 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
13160 messages when used in a user-defined command.
13161
13162 @node Hooks
13163 @section User-defined command hooks
13164 @cindex command hooks
13165 @cindex hooks, for commands
13166 @cindex hooks, pre-command
13167
13168 @kindex hook
13169 @kindex hook-
13170 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
13171 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
13172 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
13173 before that command.
13174
13175 @cindex hooks, post-command
13176 @kindex hookpost
13177 @kindex hookpost-
13178 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
13179 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
13180 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
13181 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
13182 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
13183
13184 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
13185 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
13186
13187 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
13188 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
13189
13190 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
13191 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
13192 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
13193 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
13194 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
13195
13196 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
13197 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
13198 you could define:
13199
13200 @smallexample
13201 define hook-stop
13202 handle SIGALRM nopass
13203 end
13204
13205 define hook-run
13206 handle SIGALRM pass
13207 end
13208
13209 define hook-continue
13210 handle SIGLARM pass
13211 end
13212 @end smallexample
13213
13214 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
13215 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
13216 you could define:
13217
13218 @smallexample
13219 define hook-echo
13220 echo <<<---
13221 end
13222
13223 define hookpost-echo
13224 echo --->>>\n
13225 end
13226
13227 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
13228 <<<---Hello World--->>>
13229 (@value{GDBP})
13230
13231 @end smallexample
13232
13233 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
13234 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
13235 name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
13236 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
13237 @c or not?
13238 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
13239 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
13240 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
13241
13242 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
13243 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
13244
13245 @node Command Files
13246 @section Command files
13247
13248 @cindex command files
13249 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
13250 commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
13251 An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
13252 the last command, as it would from the terminal.
13253
13254 @cindex init file
13255 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
13256 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
13257 When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
13258 @dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
13259 port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
13260 limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
13261 During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
13262
13263 @enumerate
13264 @item
13265 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
13266 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
13267 @code{HOME} environment variable.}.
13268
13269 @item
13270 Processes command line options and operands.
13271
13272 @item
13273 Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
13274
13275 @item
13276 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
13277 @end enumerate
13278
13279 The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
13280 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
13281 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
13282 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
13283
13284 @cindex init file name
13285 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
13286 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
13287 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
13288 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
13289 environments with special init file names:
13290
13291 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
13292 @itemize @bullet
13293 @item
13294 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
13295
13296 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
13297 @item
13298 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
13299
13300 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
13301 @item
13302 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
13303 @end itemize
13304
13305 You can also request the execution of a command file with the
13306 @code{source} command:
13307
13308 @table @code
13309 @kindex source
13310 @item source @var{filename}
13311 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
13312 @end table
13313
13314 The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
13315 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
13316 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
13317
13318 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
13319 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
13320 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
13321 when called from command files.
13322
13323 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
13324 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
13325 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
13326 not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
13327 the next command.
13328
13329 @smallexample
13330 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
13331 @end smallexample
13332
13333 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
13334 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
13335 would be directed to @file{log}.
13336
13337 @node Output
13338 @section Commands for controlled output
13339
13340 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13341 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13342 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13343 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13344 want.
13345
13346 @table @code
13347 @kindex echo
13348 @item echo @var{text}
13349 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13350 @c because it is not in ANSI.
13351 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13352 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13353 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13354 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13355 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13356 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
13357 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
13358 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13359 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
13360
13361 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13362 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
13363
13364 @smallexample
13365 echo This is some text\n\
13366 which is continued\n\
13367 onto several lines.\n
13368 @end smallexample
13369
13370 produces the same output as
13371
13372 @smallexample
13373 echo This is some text\n
13374 echo which is continued\n
13375 echo onto several lines.\n
13376 @end smallexample
13377
13378 @kindex output
13379 @item output @var{expression}
13380 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13381 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
13382 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
13383 on expressions.
13384
13385 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13386 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13387 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13388 formats}, for more information.
13389
13390 @kindex printf
13391 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13392 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13393 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13394 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13395 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13396 subroutine
13397 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13398 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13399 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13400 @c supported.
13401
13402 @smallexample
13403 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
13404 @end smallexample
13405
13406 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
13407
13408 @smallexample
13409 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13410 @end smallexample
13411
13412 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13413 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13414 letter.
13415 @end table
13416
13417 @node TUI
13418 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13419 @cindex TUI
13420
13421 @menu
13422 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13423 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
13424 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
13425 * TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13426 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13427 @end menu
13428
13429 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13430 is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13431 to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13432 and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13433 The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13434 with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
13435
13436 @node TUI Overview
13437 @section TUI overview
13438
13439 The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13440 @value{GDBN} runs:
13441
13442 @itemize @bullet
13443 @item
13444 A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13445 windows on the terminal.
13446
13447 @item
13448 A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13449 the TUI.
13450 @end itemize
13451
13452 In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13453 on the terminal:
13454
13455 @table @emph
13456 @item command
13457 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13458 prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13459 managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13460 window is always visible.
13461
13462 @item source
13463 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13464 line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
13465
13466 @item assembly
13467 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
13468
13469 @item register
13470 This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13471 a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13472 changed are highlighted.
13473
13474 @end table
13475
13476 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
13477 by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
13478 Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
13479 indicates the breakpoint type:
13480
13481 @table @code
13482 @item B
13483 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13484
13485 @item b
13486 Breakpoint which was never hit.
13487
13488 @item H
13489 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13490
13491 @item h
13492 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
13493
13494 @end table
13495
13496 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
13497
13498 @table @code
13499 @item +
13500 Breakpoint is enabled.
13501
13502 @item -
13503 Breakpoint is disabled.
13504
13505 @end table
13506
13507 The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13508 and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13509 changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13510 These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13511 layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13512 The following layouts are available:
13513
13514 @itemize @bullet
13515 @item
13516 source
13517
13518 @item
13519 assembly
13520
13521 @item
13522 source and assembly
13523
13524 @item
13525 source and registers
13526
13527 @item
13528 assembly and registers
13529
13530 @end itemize
13531
13532 On top of the command window a status line gives various information
13533 concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
13534 updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
13535 are displayed:
13536
13537 @table @emph
13538 @item target
13539 Indicates the current gdb target
13540 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13541
13542 @item process
13543 Gives information about the current process or thread number.
13544 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
13545
13546 @item function
13547 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
13548 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
13549 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
13550 the string @code{??} is displayed.
13551
13552 @item line
13553 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
13554 When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
13555
13556 @item pc
13557 Indicates the current program counter address.
13558
13559 @end table
13560
13561 @node TUI Keys
13562 @section TUI Key Bindings
13563 @cindex TUI key bindings
13564
13565 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13566 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13567 They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
13568 directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
13569 a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
13570 @value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
13571 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
13572
13573 @table @kbd
13574 @kindex C-x C-a
13575 @item C-x C-a
13576 @kindex C-x a
13577 @itemx C-x a
13578 @kindex C-x A
13579 @itemx C-x A
13580 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13581 the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13582 its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13583 mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13584 The screen is then refreshed.
13585
13586 @kindex C-x 1
13587 @item C-x 1
13588 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13589 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13590 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
13591
13592 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
13593
13594 @kindex C-x 2
13595 @item C-x 2
13596 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13597 layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13598 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13599 previous layout and the new one.
13600
13601 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
13602
13603 @kindex C-x s
13604 @item C-x s
13605 Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
13606 (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
13607
13608 @end table
13609
13610 The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
13611
13612 @table @key
13613 @kindex PgUp
13614 @item PgUp
13615 Scroll the active window one page up.
13616
13617 @kindex PgDn
13618 @item PgDn
13619 Scroll the active window one page down.
13620
13621 @kindex Up
13622 @item Up
13623 Scroll the active window one line up.
13624
13625 @kindex Down
13626 @item Down
13627 Scroll the active window one line down.
13628
13629 @kindex Left
13630 @item Left
13631 Scroll the active window one column left.
13632
13633 @kindex Right
13634 @item Right
13635 Scroll the active window one column right.
13636
13637 @kindex C-L
13638 @item C-L
13639 Refresh the screen.
13640
13641 @end table
13642
13643 In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13644 for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
13645 necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
13646 @key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13647
13648 @node TUI Single Key Mode
13649 @section TUI Single Key Mode
13650 @cindex TUI single key mode
13651
13652 The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
13653 key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
13654 some gdb commands.
13655
13656 @table @kbd
13657 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13658 @item c
13659 continue
13660
13661 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13662 @item d
13663 down
13664
13665 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13666 @item f
13667 finish
13668
13669 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13670 @item n
13671 next
13672
13673 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13674 @item q
13675 exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
13676
13677 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13678 @item r
13679 run
13680
13681 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13682 @item s
13683 step
13684
13685 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13686 @item u
13687 up
13688
13689 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13690 @item v
13691 info locals
13692
13693 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13694 @item w
13695 where
13696
13697 @end table
13698
13699 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
13700 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
13701 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
13702 with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
13703 @emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
13704 this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
13705
13706
13707 @node TUI Commands
13708 @section TUI specific commands
13709 @cindex TUI commands
13710
13711 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13712 These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13713 the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13714 is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13715 in the TUI mode.
13716
13717 @table @code
13718 @item info win
13719 @kindex info win
13720 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
13721
13722 @item layout next
13723 @kindex layout next
13724 Display the next layout.
13725
13726 @item layout prev
13727 @kindex layout prev
13728 Display the previous layout.
13729
13730 @item layout src
13731 @kindex layout src
13732 Display the source window only.
13733
13734 @item layout asm
13735 @kindex layout asm
13736 Display the assembly window only.
13737
13738 @item layout split
13739 @kindex layout split
13740 Display the source and assembly window.
13741
13742 @item layout regs
13743 @kindex layout regs
13744 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13745
13746 @item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13747 @kindex focus
13748 Set the focus to the named window.
13749 This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13750 can be affected to another window.
13751
13752 @item refresh
13753 @kindex refresh
13754 Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
13755
13756 @item update
13757 @kindex update
13758 Update the source window and the current execution point.
13759
13760 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
13761 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
13762 @kindex winheight
13763 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
13764 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
13765 decrease it.
13766
13767 @end table
13768
13769 @node TUI Configuration
13770 @section TUI configuration variables
13771 @cindex TUI configuration variables
13772
13773 The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
13774 appearance of windows on the terminal.
13775
13776 @table @code
13777 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
13778 @kindex set tui border-kind
13779 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
13780 The possible values are the following:
13781 @table @code
13782 @item space
13783 Use a space character to draw the border.
13784
13785 @item ascii
13786 Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
13787
13788 @item acs
13789 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
13790 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
13791
13792 @end table
13793
13794 @item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
13795 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
13796 Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
13797 The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
13798 @code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
13799
13800 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
13801 @kindex set tui border-mode
13802 Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
13803 The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
13804 @table @code
13805 @item normal
13806 Use normal attributes to display the border.
13807
13808 @item standout
13809 Use standout mode.
13810
13811 @item reverse
13812 Use reverse video mode.
13813
13814 @item half
13815 Use half bright mode.
13816
13817 @item half-standout
13818 Use half bright and standout mode.
13819
13820 @item bold
13821 Use extra bright or bold mode.
13822
13823 @item bold-standout
13824 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
13825
13826 @end table
13827
13828 @end table
13829
13830 @node Emacs
13831 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
13832
13833 @cindex Emacs
13834 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
13835 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
13836 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
13837 @value{GDBN}.
13838
13839 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
13840 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
13841 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
13842 created Emacs buffer.
13843 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
13844
13845 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
13846 things:
13847
13848 @itemize @bullet
13849 @item
13850 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
13851 @end itemize
13852
13853 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13854 and output done by the program you are debugging.
13855
13856 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13857 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13858 in this way.
13859
13860 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13861 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13862 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13863 stop.
13864
13865 @itemize @bullet
13866 @item
13867 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13868 @end itemize
13869
13870 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13871 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13872 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13873 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13874 and the source.
13875
13876 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13877 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
13878
13879 @quotation
13880 @emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13881 current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13882 the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13883 appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13884 environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13885 session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13886 back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13887 avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13888 your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13889 @kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
13890
13891 A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13892 switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13893 @value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13894 @end quotation
13895
13896 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13897 you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13898 several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13899 Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13900
13901 @smallexample
13902 (setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
13903 @end smallexample
13904
13905 @noindent
13906 (preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
13907 in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13908 ``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13909
13910 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13911 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
13912
13913 @table @kbd
13914 @item C-h m
13915 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
13916
13917 @item M-s
13918 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13919 update the display window to show the current file and location.
13920
13921 @item M-n
13922 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13923 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13924 to show the current file and location.
13925
13926 @item M-i
13927 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13928 display window accordingly.
13929
13930 @item M-x gdb-nexti
13931 Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13932 display window accordingly.
13933
13934 @item C-c C-f
13935 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13936 @code{finish} command.
13937
13938 @item M-c
13939 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13940 command.
13941
13942 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
13943
13944 @item M-u
13945 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13946 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13947 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
13948
13949 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
13950
13951 @item M-d
13952 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13953 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
13954
13955 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
13956
13957 @item C-x &
13958 Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13959 of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13960 around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13961 then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13962 argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
13963
13964 You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13965 @code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13966 otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13967 inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13968 wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13969 list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13970 formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13971 is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13972 @end table
13973
13974 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13975 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
13976
13977 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13978 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13979 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13980 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13981 frame.
13982
13983 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13984 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13985 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13986 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13987 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13988 to correspond properly with the code.
13989
13990 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13991 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13992 @ignore
13993 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13994 @kindex Epoch
13995 @kindex inspect
13996
13997 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
13998 called the @code{epoch}
13999 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
14000 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
14001 each value is printed in its own window.
14002 @end ignore
14003
14004 @include annotate.texi
14005 @include gdbmi.texinfo
14006
14007 @node GDB Bugs
14008 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
14009 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
14010 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
14011
14012 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
14013
14014 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
14015 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
14016 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
14017 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
14018
14019 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
14020 information that enables us to fix the bug.
14021
14022 @menu
14023 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
14024 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
14025 @end menu
14026
14027 @node Bug Criteria
14028 @section Have you found a bug?
14029 @cindex bug criteria
14030
14031 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
14032
14033 @itemize @bullet
14034 @cindex fatal signal
14035 @cindex debugger crash
14036 @cindex crash of debugger
14037 @item
14038 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
14039 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
14040
14041 @cindex error on valid input
14042 @item
14043 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
14044 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
14045 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
14046
14047 @cindex invalid input
14048 @item
14049 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
14050 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
14051 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
14052 for traditional practice''.
14053
14054 @item
14055 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
14056 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
14057 @end itemize
14058
14059 @node Bug Reporting
14060 @section How to report bugs
14061 @cindex bug reports
14062 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
14063
14064 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
14065 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
14066 contact that organization first.
14067
14068 You can find contact information for many support companies and
14069 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
14070 distribution.
14071 @c should add a web page ref...
14072
14073 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
14074 @value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
14075 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
14076 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
14077 be used.
14078
14079 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
14080 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
14081 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
14082 @samp{bug-gdb}.
14083
14084 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
14085 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
14086 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
14087 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
14088 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
14089 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
14090 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
14091 bug reports to the mailing list.
14092
14093 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
14094 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
14095 fact or leave it out, state it!
14096
14097 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
14098 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
14099 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
14100 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
14101 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
14102 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
14103 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
14104 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
14105 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
14106
14107 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
14108 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
14109 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
14110 self-contained.
14111
14112 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
14113 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
14114 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
14115 bugs properly.
14116
14117 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
14118
14119 @itemize @bullet
14120 @item
14121 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
14122 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
14123 version}.
14124
14125 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
14126 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
14127
14128 @item
14129 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
14130 version number.
14131
14132 @item
14133 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
14134 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
14135
14136 @item
14137 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
14138 debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
14139 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
14140 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
14141 compilers.
14142
14143 @item
14144 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
14145 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
14146 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
14147 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
14148
14149 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
14150 and then we might not encounter the bug.
14151
14152 @item
14153 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
14154 reproduce the bug.
14155
14156 @item
14157 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
14158 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
14159
14160 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
14161 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
14162 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
14163 a chance to make a mistake.
14164
14165 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
14166 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
14167 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
14168 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
14169 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
14170 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
14171 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
14172 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
14173
14174 @item
14175 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
14176 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
14177 it by context, not by line number.
14178
14179 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
14180 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
14181
14182 @end itemize
14183
14184 Here are some things that are not necessary:
14185
14186 @itemize @bullet
14187 @item
14188 A description of the envelope of the bug.
14189
14190 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
14191 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
14192 changes will not affect it.
14193
14194 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
14195 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
14196 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
14197 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
14198
14199 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
14200 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
14201 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
14202 less time, and so on.
14203
14204 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
14205 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
14206
14207 @item
14208 A patch for the bug.
14209
14210 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
14211 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
14212 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
14213 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
14214
14215 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
14216 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
14217 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
14218 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
14219
14220 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
14221 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
14222 help us to understand.
14223
14224 @item
14225 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
14226
14227 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
14228 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
14229 @end itemize
14230
14231 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
14232 @c and consists of the two following files:
14233 @c rluser.texinfo
14234 @c inc-hist.texinfo
14235 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
14236 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
14237 @include rluser.texinfo
14238 @include inc-hist.texinfo
14239
14240
14241 @node Formatting Documentation
14242 @appendix Formatting Documentation
14243
14244 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
14245 @cindex reference card
14246 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
14247 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
14248 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
14249 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
14250 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
14251 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
14252
14253 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
14254 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
14255
14256 @smallexample
14257 make refcard.dvi
14258 @end smallexample
14259
14260 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
14261 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
14262 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
14263 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
14264 your @sc{dvi} output program.
14265
14266 @cindex documentation
14267
14268 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
14269 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
14270 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
14271 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
14272 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
14273 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
14274
14275 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
14276 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
14277 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
14278 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
14279 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
14280 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
14281 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
14282 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
14283
14284 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
14285 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
14286 @code{makeinfo}.
14287
14288 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
14289 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
14290 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
14291
14292 @smallexample
14293 cd gdb
14294 make gdb.info
14295 @end smallexample
14296
14297 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
14298 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
14299 Texinfo definitions file.
14300
14301 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
14302 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
14303 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
14304 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
14305 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
14306 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
14307 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
14308
14309 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
14310 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
14311 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
14312 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
14313 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
14314 directory.
14315
14316 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
14317 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
14318 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
14319 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
14320
14321 @smallexample
14322 make gdb.dvi
14323 @end smallexample
14324
14325 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
14326
14327 @node Installing GDB
14328 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
14329 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
14330 @cindex installation
14331
14332 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
14333 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
14334 build the @code{gdb} program.
14335 @iftex
14336 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
14337 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
14338 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
14339 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
14340 @end iftex
14341
14342 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
14343 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
14344 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
14345
14346 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
14347 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
14348
14349 @table @code
14350 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
14351 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
14352
14353 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
14354 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
14355
14356 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14357 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
14358
14359 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
14360 @sc{gnu} include files
14361
14362 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
14363 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
14364
14365 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
14366 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
14367
14368 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
14369 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
14370
14371 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
14372 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
14373
14374 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
14375 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
14376 @end table
14377
14378 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
14379 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
14380 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
14381
14382 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
14383 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
14384 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
14385 argument.
14386
14387 For example:
14388
14389 @smallexample
14390 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14391 ./configure @var{host}
14392 make
14393 @end smallexample
14394
14395 @noindent
14396 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
14397 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
14398 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
14399 correct value by examining your system.)
14400
14401 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
14402 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
14403 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
14404 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
14405
14406 @need 750
14407 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
14408 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
14409 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
14410
14411 @smallexample
14412 sh configure @var{host}
14413 @end smallexample
14414
14415 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
14416 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
14417 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
14418 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
14419 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
14420
14421 You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
14422 subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
14423 configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
14424
14425 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
14426 the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
14427
14428 @smallexample
14429 @group
14430 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14431 ../configure @var{host}
14432 @end group
14433 @end smallexample
14434
14435 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
14436 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
14437 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
14438 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
14439 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
14440
14441 @menu
14442 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
14443 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
14444 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
14445 @end menu
14446
14447 @node Separate Objdir
14448 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
14449
14450 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
14451 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
14452 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
14453 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
14454 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
14455 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
14456 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
14457 program specified there.
14458
14459 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
14460 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
14461 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
14462 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
14463 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
14464 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
14465
14466 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
14467 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
14468
14469 @smallexample
14470 @group
14471 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14472 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
14473 cd ../gdb-sun4
14474 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
14475 make
14476 @end group
14477 @end smallexample
14478
14479 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
14480 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
14481 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
14482 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
14483 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
14484 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
14485
14486 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
14487 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
14488 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
14489 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
14490 You specify a cross-debugging target by
14491 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
14492
14493 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
14494 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
14495 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
14496
14497 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
14498 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
14499 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
14500 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
14501 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
14502
14503 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
14504 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
14505 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
14506 with each other.
14507
14508 @node Config Names
14509 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
14510
14511 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
14512 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
14513 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
14514 of information in the following pattern:
14515
14516 @smallexample
14517 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
14518 @end smallexample
14519
14520 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
14521 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
14522 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
14523
14524 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
14525 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
14526 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
14527 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
14528 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
14529 abbreviations---for example:
14530
14531 @smallexample
14532 % sh config.sub i386-linux
14533 i386-pc-linux-gnu
14534 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
14535 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
14536 % sh config.sub hp9k700
14537 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
14538 % sh config.sub sun4
14539 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
14540 % sh config.sub sun3
14541 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
14542 % sh config.sub i986v
14543 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
14544 @end smallexample
14545
14546 @noindent
14547 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
14548 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
14549
14550 @node Configure Options
14551 @section @code{configure} options
14552
14553 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
14554 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
14555 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
14556 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
14557
14558 @smallexample
14559 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
14560 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14561 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14562 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
14563 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
14564 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
14565 @var{host}
14566 @end smallexample
14567
14568 @noindent
14569 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
14570 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
14571 @samp{--}.
14572
14573 @table @code
14574 @item --help
14575 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
14576
14577 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
14578 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
14579 @file{@var{dir}}.
14580
14581 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
14582 Configure the source to install programs under directory
14583 @file{@var{dir}}.
14584
14585 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
14586 @need 2000
14587 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
14588 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
14589 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
14590 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
14591 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
14592 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
14593 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
14594 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
14595 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
14596 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
14597 @var{dirname}.
14598
14599 @item --norecursion
14600 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
14601 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
14602
14603 @item --target=@var{target}
14604 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
14605 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
14606 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
14607
14608 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
14609
14610 @item @var{host} @dots{}
14611 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
14612
14613 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
14614 @end table
14615
14616 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
14617 needed for special purposes only.
14618
14619 @node Maintenance Commands
14620 @appendix Maintenance Commands
14621 @cindex maintenance commands
14622 @cindex internal commands
14623
14624 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
14625 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
14626 These commands are provided here for reference.
14627
14628 @table @code
14629 @kindex maint info breakpoints
14630 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
14631 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
14632 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
14633 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
14634 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
14635 is shown:
14636
14637 @table @code
14638 @item breakpoint
14639 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
14640
14641 @item watchpoint
14642 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
14643
14644 @item longjmp
14645 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
14646 @code{longjmp} calls.
14647
14648 @item longjmp resume
14649 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
14650
14651 @item until
14652 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
14653
14654 @item finish
14655 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
14656
14657 @item shlib events
14658 Shared library events.
14659
14660 @end table
14661
14662 @kindex maint internal-error
14663 @kindex maint internal-warning
14664 @item maint internal-error
14665 @itemx maint internal-warning
14666 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
14667 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
14668 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
14669 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
14670 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
14671 @value{GDBN} session.
14672
14673 @smallexample
14674 (gdb) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
14675 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
14676 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
14677 debugging may prove unreliable.
14678 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14679 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14680 (gdb)
14681 @end smallexample
14682
14683 Takes an optional parameter that is used as the text of the error or
14684 warning message.
14685
14686 @kindex maint print registers
14687 @kindex maint print raw-registers
14688 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
14689 @item maint print registers
14690 @itemx maint print raw-registers
14691 @itemx maint print cooked-registers
14692 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
14693
14694 The command @samp{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
14695 the raw register cache; and the command @samp{maint print
14696 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers.
14697 @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint, @value{GDBN} Internals}.
14698
14699 Takes an optional file parameter.
14700
14701 @end table
14702
14703
14704 @node Remote Protocol
14705 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
14706
14707 @menu
14708 * Overview::
14709 * Packets::
14710 * Stop Reply Packets::
14711 * General Query Packets::
14712 * Register Packet Format::
14713 * Examples::
14714 @end menu
14715
14716 @node Overview
14717 @section Overview
14718
14719 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
14720 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
14721 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
14722 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
14723
14724 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
14725 transmitted and received data respectfully.
14726
14727 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
14728 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
14729 @cindex remote serial protocol
14730 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
14731 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
14732 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
14733 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
14734
14735 @smallexample
14736 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14737 @end smallexample
14738 @noindent
14739
14740 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
14741 @noindent
14742 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
14743 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
14744 eight bit unsigned checksum).
14745
14746 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
14747 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
14748
14749 @smallexample
14750 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14751 @end smallexample
14752
14753 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
14754 @noindent
14755 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
14756 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
14757 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
14758
14759 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
14760 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
14761 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
14762 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
14763 retransmission):
14764
14765 @smallexample
14766 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14767 <- @code{+}
14768 @end smallexample
14769 @noindent
14770
14771 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
14772 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
14773 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
14774 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
14775
14776 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
14777 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
14778 exceptions).
14779
14780 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
14781 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
14782 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
14783 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
14784
14785 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
14786 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
14787 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
14788
14789 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
14790 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
14791 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
14792 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
14793 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
14794 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
14795 value greater than 126 should not be used.
14796
14797 Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
14798 loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
14799 character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
14800
14801 So:
14802 @smallexample
14803 "@code{0* }"
14804 @end smallexample
14805 @noindent
14806 means the same as "0000".
14807
14808 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
14809 error number. That number is not well defined.
14810
14811 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
14812 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
14813 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
14814 on that response.
14815
14816 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
14817 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
14818 optional.
14819
14820 @node Packets
14821 @section Packets
14822
14823 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
14824 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
14825
14826 @table @r
14827
14828 @item @code{!} --- extended mode
14829 @cindex @code{!} packet
14830
14831 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
14832 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
14833 debugged.
14834
14835 Reply:
14836 @table @samp
14837 @item OK
14838 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
14839 @end table
14840
14841 @item @code{?} --- last signal
14842 @cindex @code{?} packet
14843
14844 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
14845 step and continue.
14846
14847 Reply:
14848 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14849
14850 @item @code{a} --- reserved
14851
14852 Reserved for future use.
14853
14854 @item @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,@dots{}} --- set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
14855 @cindex @code{A} packet
14856
14857 Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
14858 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
14859 See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
14860
14861 Reply:
14862 @table @samp
14863 @item OK
14864 @item E@var{NN}
14865 @end table
14866
14867 @item @code{b}@var{baud} --- set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
14868 @cindex @code{b} packet
14869
14870 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
14871
14872 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
14873 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
14874 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
14875
14876 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
14877 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
14878 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
14879 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
14880 of view, nothing actually happened.}
14881
14882 @item @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode} --- set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
14883 @cindex @code{B} packet
14884
14885 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
14886 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
14887
14888 This packet has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets
14889 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
14890
14891 @item @code{c}@var{addr} --- continue
14892 @cindex @code{c} packet
14893
14894 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
14895 current address.
14896
14897 Reply:
14898 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14899
14900 @item @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- continue with signal
14901 @cindex @code{C} packet
14902
14903 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
14904 @code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
14905
14906 Reply:
14907 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14908
14909 @item @code{d} --- toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
14910 @cindex @code{d} packet
14911
14912 Toggle debug flag.
14913
14914 @item @code{D} --- detach
14915 @cindex @code{D} packet
14916
14917 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
14918 before @value{GDBN} disconnects.
14919
14920 Reply:
14921 @table @samp
14922 @item @emph{no response}
14923 @value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
14924 @end table
14925
14926 @item @code{e} --- reserved
14927
14928 Reserved for future use.
14929
14930 @item @code{E} --- reserved
14931
14932 Reserved for future use.
14933
14934 @item @code{f} --- reserved
14935
14936 Reserved for future use.
14937
14938 @item @code{F} --- reserved
14939
14940 Reserved for future use.
14941
14942 @item @code{g} --- read registers
14943 @anchor{read registers packet}
14944 @cindex @code{g} packet
14945
14946 Read general registers.
14947
14948 Reply:
14949 @table @samp
14950 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
14951 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
14952 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
14953 each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
14954 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}
14955 and @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
14956 @code{g} packets is specified below.
14957 @item E@var{NN}
14958 for an error.
14959 @end table
14960
14961 @item @code{G}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write regs
14962 @cindex @code{G} packet
14963
14964 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of the @var{XX@dots{}}
14965 data.
14966
14967 Reply:
14968 @table @samp
14969 @item OK
14970 for success
14971 @item E@var{NN}
14972 for an error
14973 @end table
14974
14975 @item @code{h} --- reserved
14976
14977 Reserved for future use.
14978
14979 @item @code{H}@var{c}@var{t@dots{}} --- set thread
14980 @cindex @code{H} packet
14981
14982 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
14983 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
14984 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
14985 operations. The thread designator @var{t@dots{}} may be -1, meaning all
14986 the threads, a thread number, or zero which means pick any thread.
14987
14988 Reply:
14989 @table @samp
14990 @item OK
14991 for success
14992 @item E@var{NN}
14993 for an error
14994 @end table
14995
14996 @c FIXME: JTC:
14997 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
14998 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
14999 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
15000 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
15001 @c described. For example:
15002 @c
15003 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
15004 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
15005 @c otherwise returns current registers.
15006 @c
15007 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
15008 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
15009 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
15010
15011 @item @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn} --- cycle step @strong{(draft)}
15012 @anchor{cycle step packet}
15013 @cindex @code{i} packet
15014
15015 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
15016 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
15017 step starting at that address.
15018
15019 @item @code{I} --- signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
15020 @cindex @code{I} packet
15021
15022 @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle step packet}.
15023
15024 @item @code{j} --- reserved
15025
15026 Reserved for future use.
15027
15028 @item @code{J} --- reserved
15029
15030 Reserved for future use.
15031
15032 @item @code{k} --- kill request
15033 @cindex @code{k} packet
15034
15035 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
15036 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
15037 thread?)}.
15038
15039 @item @code{K} --- reserved
15040
15041 Reserved for future use.
15042
15043 @item @code{l} --- reserved
15044
15045 Reserved for future use.
15046
15047 @item @code{L} --- reserved
15048
15049 Reserved for future use.
15050
15051 @item @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- read memory
15052 @cindex @code{m} packet
15053
15054 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
15055 Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are
15056 assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
15057 transfer mechanism is needed.}
15058
15059 Reply:
15060 @table @samp
15061 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
15062 @var{XX@dots{}} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
15063 to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume
15064 that sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned
15065 accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is
15066 needed.}
15067 @item E@var{NN}
15068 @var{NN} is errno
15069 @end table
15070
15071 @item @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem
15072 @cindex @code{M} packet
15073
15074 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
15075 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data.
15076
15077 Reply:
15078 @table @samp
15079 @item OK
15080 for success
15081 @item E@var{NN}
15082 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
15083 written).
15084 @end table
15085
15086 @item @code{n} --- reserved
15087
15088 Reserved for future use.
15089
15090 @item @code{N} --- reserved
15091
15092 Reserved for future use.
15093
15094 @item @code{o} --- reserved
15095
15096 Reserved for future use.
15097
15098 @item @code{O} --- reserved
15099
15100 Reserved for future use.
15101
15102 @item @code{p}@var{n@dots{}} --- read reg @strong{(reserved)}
15103 @cindex @code{p} packet
15104
15105 @xref{write register packet}.
15106
15107 Reply:
15108 @table @samp
15109 @item @var{r@dots{}.}
15110 The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
15111 @end table
15112
15113 @item @code{P}@var{n@dots{}}@code{=}@var{r@dots{}} --- write register
15114 @anchor{write register packet}
15115 @cindex @code{P} packet
15116
15117 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}, which contains two hex
15118 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
15119
15120 Reply:
15121 @table @samp
15122 @item OK
15123 for success
15124 @item E@var{NN}
15125 for an error
15126 @end table
15127
15128 @item @code{q}@var{query} --- general query
15129 @anchor{general query packet}
15130 @cindex @code{q} packet
15131
15132 Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries have a
15133 leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a company
15134 prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may optionally
15135 be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs must ensure
15136 that they match the full @var{query} name.
15137
15138 Reply:
15139 @table @samp
15140 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
15141 Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
15142 @item E@var{NN}
15143 error reply
15144 @item
15145 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
15146 @end table
15147
15148 @item @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val} --- general set
15149 @cindex @code{Q} packet
15150
15151 Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.
15152
15153 @xref{general query packet}, for a discussion of naming conventions.
15154
15155 @item @code{r} --- reset @strong{(deprecated)}
15156 @cindex @code{r} packet
15157
15158 Reset the entire system.
15159
15160 @item @code{R}@var{XX} --- remote restart
15161 @cindex @code{R} packet
15162
15163 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
15164 This packet is only available in extended mode.
15165
15166 Reply:
15167 @table @samp
15168 @item @emph{no reply}
15169 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
15170 @end table
15171
15172 @item @code{s}@var{addr} --- step
15173 @cindex @code{s} packet
15174
15175 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
15176 same address.
15177
15178 Reply:
15179 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
15180
15181 @item @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- step with signal
15182 @anchor{step with signal packet}
15183 @cindex @code{S} packet
15184
15185 Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
15186
15187 Reply:
15188 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
15189
15190 @item @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM} --- search
15191 @cindex @code{t} packet
15192
15193 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
15194 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
15195 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
15196
15197 @item @code{T}@var{XX} --- thread alive
15198 @cindex @code{T} packet
15199
15200 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
15201
15202 Reply:
15203 @table @samp
15204 @item OK
15205 thread is still alive
15206 @item E@var{NN}
15207 thread is dead
15208 @end table
15209
15210 @item @code{u} --- reserved
15211
15212 Reserved for future use.
15213
15214 @item @code{U} --- reserved
15215
15216 Reserved for future use.
15217
15218 @item @code{v} --- reserved
15219
15220 Reserved for future use.
15221
15222 @item @code{V} --- reserved
15223
15224 Reserved for future use.
15225
15226 @item @code{w} --- reserved
15227
15228 Reserved for future use.
15229
15230 @item @code{W} --- reserved
15231
15232 Reserved for future use.
15233
15234 @item @code{x} --- reserved
15235
15236 Reserved for future use.
15237
15238 @item @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem (binary)
15239 @cindex @code{X} packet
15240
15241 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX@dots{}}
15242 is binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
15243 escaped using @code{0x7d}.
15244
15245 Reply:
15246 @table @samp
15247 @item OK
15248 for success
15249 @item E@var{NN}
15250 for an error
15251 @end table
15252
15253 @item @code{y} --- reserved
15254
15255 Reserved for future use.
15256
15257 @item @code{Y} reserved
15258
15259 Reserved for future use.
15260
15261 @item @code{z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15262 @itemx @code{Z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15263 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
15264 @cindex @code{z} packet
15265 @cindex @code{Z} packets
15266
15267 Insert (@code{Z}) or remove (@code{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
15268 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
15269 @var{length} bytes.
15270
15271 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
15272 separately.
15273
15274 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return @samp{} for an
15275 unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A remote
15276 target shall support either both or neither of a given
15277 @code{Z}@var{type}@dots{} and @code{z}@var{type}@dots{} packet pair. To
15278 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
15279 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
15280
15281 @item @code{z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15282 @item @code{Z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15283 @cindex @code{z0} packet
15284 @cindex @code{Z0} packet
15285
15286 Insert (@code{Z0}) or remove (@code{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
15287 @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
15288
15289 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
15290 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
15291 @code{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
15292 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
15293 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
15294
15295 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
15296 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
15297 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
15298 target, is not defined.}
15299
15300 Reply:
15301 @table @samp
15302 @item OK
15303 success
15304 @item
15305 not supported
15306 @item E@var{NN}
15307 for an error
15308 @end table
15309
15310 @item @code{z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15311 @item @code{Z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15312 @cindex @code{z1} packet
15313 @cindex @code{Z1} packet
15314
15315 Insert (@code{Z1}) or remove (@code{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
15316 address @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
15317
15318 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
15319 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
15320
15321 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
15322 movement.}
15323
15324 Reply:
15325 @table @samp
15326 @item OK
15327 success
15328 @item
15329 not supported
15330 @item E@var{NN}
15331 for an error
15332 @end table
15333
15334 @item @code{z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15335 @item @code{Z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15336 @cindex @code{z2} packet
15337 @cindex @code{Z2} packet
15338
15339 Insert (@code{Z2}) or remove (@code{z2}) a write watchpoint.
15340
15341 Reply:
15342 @table @samp
15343 @item OK
15344 success
15345 @item
15346 not supported
15347 @item E@var{NN}
15348 for an error
15349 @end table
15350
15351 @item @code{z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15352 @item @code{Z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15353 @cindex @code{z3} packet
15354 @cindex @code{Z3} packet
15355
15356 Insert (@code{Z3}) or remove (@code{z3}) a write watchpoint.
15357
15358 Reply:
15359 @table @samp
15360 @item OK
15361 success
15362 @item
15363 not supported
15364 @item E@var{NN}
15365 for an error
15366 @end table
15367
15368 @item @code{z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15369 @item @code{Z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15370 @cindex @code{z4} packet
15371 @cindex @code{Z4} packet
15372
15373 Insert (@code{Z4}) or remove (@code{z4}) an access watchpoint.
15374
15375 Reply:
15376 @table @samp
15377 @item OK
15378 success
15379 @item
15380 not supported
15381 @item E@var{NN}
15382 for an error
15383 @end table
15384
15385 @end table
15386
15387 @node Stop Reply Packets
15388 @section Stop Reply Packets
15389 @cindex stop reply packets
15390
15391 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
15392 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
15393 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
15394 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
15395 number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
15396 conventions is used.
15397
15398 @table @samp
15399
15400 @item S@var{AA}
15401 @var{AA} is the signal number
15402
15403 @item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
15404 @cindex @code{T} packet reply
15405
15406 @var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
15407 (hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
15408 by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
15409 thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = (@samp{watch} |
15410 @samp{rwatch} | @samp{awatch}, @var{r...} = data address, this is a hex
15411 integer; @var{n...} = other string not starting with valid hex digit.
15412 @value{GDBN} should ignore this @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on
15413 to the next. This way we can extend the protocol.
15414
15415 @item W@var{AA}
15416
15417 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
15418 applicable to certain targets.
15419
15420 @item X@var{AA}
15421
15422 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
15423
15424 @item N@var{AA};@var{t@dots{}};@var{d@dots{}};@var{b@dots{}} @strong{(obsolete)}
15425
15426 @var{AA} = signal number; @var{t@dots{}} = address of symbol
15427 @code{_start}; @var{d@dots{}} = base of data section; @var{b@dots{}} =
15428 base of bss section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets.
15429 The difference between this reply and the @samp{qOffsets} query is that
15430 the @samp{N} packet may arrive spontaneously whereas the @samp{qOffsets}
15431 is a query initiated by the host debugger.}
15432
15433 @item O@var{XX@dots{}}
15434
15435 @var{XX@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at
15436 any time while the program is running and the debugger should continue
15437 to wait for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
15438
15439 @end table
15440
15441 @node General Query Packets
15442 @section General Query Packets
15443
15444 The following set and query packets have already been defined.
15445
15446 @table @r
15447
15448 @item @code{q}@code{C} --- current thread
15449
15450 Return the current thread id.
15451
15452 Reply:
15453 @table @samp
15454 @item @code{QC}@var{pid}
15455 Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
15456 @item *
15457 Any other reply implies the old pid.
15458 @end table
15459
15460 @item @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} -- all thread ids
15461
15462 @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
15463
15464 Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
15465 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
15466 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
15467 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
15468 be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
15469 sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
15470
15471 NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
15472
15473 Reply:
15474 @table @samp
15475 @item @code{m}@var{id}
15476 A single thread id
15477 @item @code{m}@var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
15478 a comma-separated list of thread ids
15479 @item @code{l}
15480 (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
15481 @end table
15482
15483 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
15484 more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. @value{GDBN}
15485 will respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
15486 @code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
15487 (lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
15488
15489 @item @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id} --- extra thread info
15490
15491 Where @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. Obtain a printable
15492 string description of a thread's attributes from the target OS. This
15493 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting for
15494 @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is displayed
15495 in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display. Some examples of
15496 possible thread extra info strings are ``Runnable'', or ``Blocked on
15497 Mutex''.
15498
15499 Reply:
15500 @table @samp
15501 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
15502 Where @var{XX@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising
15503 the printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
15504 attributes.
15505 @end table
15506
15507 @item @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread} --- query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
15508
15509 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
15510 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
15511 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
15512 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
15513 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
15514 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
15515
15516 NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} query
15517 (see above).
15518
15519 Reply:
15520 @table @samp
15521 @item @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread@dots{}}
15522 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
15523 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
15524 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
15525 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread@dots{}}
15526 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
15527 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
15528 @end table
15529
15530 @item @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- compute CRC of memory block
15531
15532 Reply:
15533 @table @samp
15534 @item @code{E}@var{NN}
15535 An error (such as memory fault)
15536 @item @code{C}@var{CRC32}
15537 A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
15538 @end table
15539
15540 @item @code{q}@code{Offsets} --- query sect offs
15541
15542 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
15543 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
15544 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
15545 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
15546
15547 Reply:
15548 @table @samp
15549 @item @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
15550 @end table
15551
15552 @item @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid} --- thread info request
15553
15554 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
15555 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
15556
15557 Reply:
15558 @table @samp
15559 @item *
15560 @end table
15561
15562 See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
15563
15564 @item @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{command} --- remote command
15565
15566 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
15567 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
15568 Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
15569 number of intermediate @code{O}@var{output} console output packets.
15570 @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a stubs's
15571 interpreter may have security implications}.
15572
15573 Reply:
15574 @table @samp
15575 @item OK
15576 A command response with no output.
15577 @item @var{OUTPUT}
15578 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
15579 @item @code{E}@var{NN}
15580 Indicate a badly formed request.
15581 @item @samp{}
15582 When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
15583 @end table
15584
15585 @item @code{qSymbol::} --- symbol lookup
15586
15587 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
15588 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
15589
15590 Reply:
15591 @table @samp
15592 @item @code{OK}
15593 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
15594 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15595 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
15596 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
15597 @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} message, described below.
15598 @end table
15599
15600 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} --- symbol value
15601
15602 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
15603
15604 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
15605 target has previously requested.
15606
15607 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
15608 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
15609 will be empty.
15610
15611 Reply:
15612 @table @samp
15613 @item @code{OK}
15614 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
15615 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15616 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
15617 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
15618 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
15619 @end table
15620
15621 @end table
15622
15623 @node Register Packet Format
15624 @section Register Packet Format
15625
15626 The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
15627 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
15628 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
15629 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
15630 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
15631 most-significant - least-significant.
15632
15633 @table @r
15634
15635 @item MIPS32
15636
15637 All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
15638 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
15639 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
15640
15641 @item MIPS64
15642
15643 All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
15644 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
15645 as @code{MIPS32}.
15646
15647 @end table
15648
15649 @node Examples
15650 @section Examples
15651
15652 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
15653 does not get any direct output:
15654
15655 @smallexample
15656 -> @code{R00}
15657 <- @code{+}
15658 @emph{target restarts}
15659 -> @code{?}
15660 <- @code{+}
15661 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
15662 -> @code{+}
15663 @end smallexample
15664
15665 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
15666
15667 @smallexample
15668 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
15669 <- @code{+}
15670 -> @code{s}
15671 <- @code{+}
15672 @emph{time passes}
15673 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
15674 -> @code{+}
15675 -> @code{g}
15676 <- @code{+}
15677 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
15678 -> @code{+}
15679 @end smallexample
15680
15681 @include gpl.texi
15682
15683 @include fdl.texi
15684
15685 @node Index
15686 @unnumbered Index
15687
15688 @printindex cp
15689
15690 @tex
15691 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
15692 % meantime:
15693 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
15694 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
15695 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
15696 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
15697 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
15698 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
15699 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
15700 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
15701 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
15702 \page\colophon
15703 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
15704 @end tex
15705
15706 @bye